Siemens Gigaset S675 Specifications

s
Gigaset S685 IP / S675 IP
Gigaset
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / overview.fm / 27.10.08
The handset at a glance
The handset at a glance
19
18
17
16
Ð
½
V
1
2
INT 1
15.01.08
?
09:45
SMS
3
15
14
13
12
11
5
10
6
9
7
8
Handset keys
Version 4, 16.09.2005
1 Display in idle status (example)
2 Charge status of the batteries
e V U (1/3 charged to
fully charged)
= flashes: battery almost
flat
e V U flashes: battery
charging
3 Display keys (page 32)
4
4 Message key
Opens calls and message lists
Flashes: new message or new call
5 End call key, On/Off key
End call, cancel function, go back one menu
level (press briefly), back to idle status
(press and hold), activate/deactivate
handset (press and hold in idle status)
6 Hash key
Keypad lock on/off (press and hold,
page 31)
Switch between upper/lower case letters
and digits for text input (page 148)
7 Call-by-call list key (not for VoIP)
Open call-by-call list
8 Microphone
9 Recall key
Fixed line network:
enter flash (press briefly)
insert a pause (press and hold)
VoIP: enter Flash (adjustable, page 122)
10 Star key
Idle status: ringer tones on/off
(press and hold)
Fixed line network: switch between
dial pulsing/touch tone dialling
Editor: open special characters table
11 Key 1 (press and hold)
Call the network mailbox or answer machine
(Gigaset S675/S685 IP)
12 Connection socket for headset (page 19)
13 Talk key
Accept call, open last number redial list
(press briefly in idle status), select connection type and start dialling (press briefly/
press and hold after entering the number,
page 26)
SMS editor: send SMS
14 Handsfree key
Change between speaker/handsfree mode
Lights up: handsfree talking activated
Flashes: incoming call
15 Control key (page 32)
16 Eco mode activated (page 20)
17 Signal strength
Ò Ñ i (low to high)
| flashes: no reception
18 Gigaset S68H handset:
Bluetooth activated (page 94)
19 Answer machine icon
Answer machine switched on;
Flashes: answer machine is recording a
message or is being operated by another
internal party
1
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / overview.fm / 27.10.08
The base station at a glance
The base station at a glance
1
Base station key
1 Paging key
Lights up:
LAN connection active (phone is connected
to router)
Flashes:
data transfer to LAN connection
Press briefly:
start paging (page 82), display IP address on
handset
Press and hold:
set base station to registration mode
(page 81)
Gigaset service contact numbers:
Version 4, 16.09.2005
For personal advice on our range of products and for repairs or guarantee/warranty claims call:
Service Centre UK:
08453 6708 12
(local call cost charge)
Please have your proof of purchase ready when calling.
2
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / S675-S685-IP_Lang_BAIVZ.fm / 27.10.08
Contents
Contents
The handset at a glance
Menu guidance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
Correcting incorrect entries . . . . . . . . 33
......1
The base station at a glance . . . . 2
Safety precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
Gigaset S685/S675 IP –
more than just a telephone . . . . . 8
VoIP – making calls via
the Internet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
Gigaset HDSP – telephony with
brilliant sound quality . . . . . . . . . 9
First steps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
Pack contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Setting up the handset for use . . . . . .
Installing the base station . . . . . . . . .
Connecting the base station . . . . . . .
Making settings for VoIP telephony . .
Belt clip and headset . . . . . . . . . . . . .
10
10
12
13
15
19
ECO DECT:
reducing the transmission power
and power consumption . . . . . . 20
Menu trees . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Phone menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Web configurator menu . . . . . . . . . . . 25
Making calls with VoIP and
the fixed line network . . . . . . . . 26
Making an external call . . . . . . . . . . .
Ending a call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Accepting a call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Calling Line Identification . . . . . . . . .
Handsfree talking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Muting the handset . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
26
28
28
29
31
31
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Operating the handset . . . . . . . . 31
Activating/deactivating the handset .
Activating/deactivating the
keypad lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Control key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Display keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Reverting to idle status . . . . . . . . . . . .
31
31
32
32
33
VoIP telephony via
Gigaset.net . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
Searching for subscribers in the
Gigaset.net directory . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
Entering, editing and deleting
own entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Calling a Gigaset.net subscriber . . . . . 36
Network services . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Anonymous calling –
withholding caller ID . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Further network services in the
fixed line network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Further network services for VoIP . . . . 39
Using the directory and lists . . 41
Directory/call-by-call list . . . . . . . . . . .
Using online directories . . . . . . . . . . .
Last number redial list . . . . . . . . . . . .
Opening lists with the
message key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
41
45
48
48
Making cost-effective calls . . . . 51
SMS (text messages) . . . . . . . . . 53
Writing/sending an SMS . . . . . . . . . . .
Receiving an SMS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Notification by SMS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
SMS mailboxes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Setting SMS centres . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
SMS on a PABX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Activating/deactivating SMS function .
SMS troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . .
54
55
57
57
58
59
59
60
Gigaset S675/S685 IP:
operating the base station
answer machine . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
Operation via the handset . . . . . . . . .
Activating/deactivating call screening
Setting up the answer machine . . . . .
Configuring the network mailbox
for fast access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Operating when on the move
(remote operation) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
61
65
65
66
66
3
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / S675-S685-IP_Lang_BAIVZ.fm / 27.10.08
Contents
E-mail notifications . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Opening the incoming e-mail list . . . 68
Viewing the message header of
an e-mail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
Viewing an e-mail sender's
address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Messenger . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Establishing a connection,
going online . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Changing/checking your personal status,
going offline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
Opening the buddy list . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Receiving messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
Writing and sending messages . . . . . 76
Calling a buddy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
Self-help with errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
Using the network mailbox . . . . 78
Activating/deactivating the network mailbox, entering numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Configuring the (network) mailbox for fast
access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79
Listening to messages on the network
mailbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
Using several handsets . . . . . . . . 81
Registering handsets . . . . . . . . . . . . .
De-registering handsets . . . . . . . . . . .
Locating a handset ("paging") . . . . . .
Changing the base station . . . . . . . . .
Changing a handset's
internal number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Changing the name of a handset . . . .
Making internal calls . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Using a handset as a
room monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
81
82
82
82
82
83
83
84
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Handset settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Changing the display language . . . . .
Setting the display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Setting the screensaver . . . . . . . . . . .
Setting the display backlight . . . . . . .
Shortcuts for functions and
numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Activating/deactivating
auto answer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4
86
86
86
87
87
88
Changing the handsfree/
earpiece volume . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Changing ringer tones . . . . . . . . . . . .
Activating/deactivating
advisory tones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
My stuff . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Setting the alarm clock . . . . . . . . . . . .
Setting an appointment (calendar) . .
Displaying missed appointments
and anniversaries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Gigaset S68H handset:
using Bluetooth devices . . . . . . . . . . .
Setting your own area code . . . . . . . .
Restoring the handset to the factory
settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
88
89
90
90
91
92
93
93
95
96
Base station settings . . . . . . . . . 96
Protecting against unauthorised
access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Restoring the base station to the
factory settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Activating/deactivating
music on hold . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Activating/deactivating
repeater mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Set default connection . . . . . . . . . . . .
Updating the base station firmware . .
96
96
97
98
98
98
Making VoIP settings . . . . . . . . . 99
Using the connection assistant . . . . . . 99
Changing settings without the
connection assistant . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Setting the phone's IP address in
the LAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
Activating/deactivating display
of VoIP status messages . . . . . . . . . . 102
Checking the base station
MAC address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Operating the base station
on the PABX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Changing the dialling mode . . . . . . .
Setting recall . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Setting pauses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Switching temporarily to
tone dialling (DTMF) . . . . . . . . . . . . .
102
102
103
103
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / S675-S685-IP_Lang_BAIVZ.fm / 27.10.08
Contents
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Web configurator –configuring
phone via PC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
Connecting PC with
Web configurator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
Logging in, setting the Web configurator
language . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Logging off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Structure of the Web pages . . . . . . . 106
Opening Web pages . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
Setting the phone with
Web configurator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
IP Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
Configuring telephone
connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
Optimising voice quality for
VoIP connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Setting the telephone default
connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
Assigning send and receive numbers
to handsets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Gigaset S675/S685 IP:
assigning receive numbers to
the answer machine . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
Activating Call Forwarding for
VoIP connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
Setting the DTMF-reminder for VoIP 122
Defining recall key functions for
VoIP (hook flash) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
Defining local communication ports for
VoIP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
Configuring call forwarding
via VoIP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
Setting area code predialling . . . . . . 123
Defining dialling plans –
cost control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Activating/deactivating network mailbox,
entering numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
Saving messenger access data . . . . . 126
Making e-mail settings . . . . . . . . . . . 128
Activating/deactivating info
services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
Selecting and registering online directories for access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
Changing internal handset numbers
and names . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
Loading and deleting handset directories
to/from the PC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
Activating VoIP status message
display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
Starting a firmware update . . . . . . . . 132
Activating/deactivating the
automatic version check . . . . . . . . . . 133
Copying the date/time from
time server . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134
Querying the phone status . . . . . . . . 135
Appendix . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Contact with liquid . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Questions and answers . . . . . . . . . . .
Checking service information . . . . . .
Service (Customer Care) . . . . . . . . . .
Authorisation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Guarantee Certificate
United Kingdom . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Icons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Example of a menu input . . . . . . . . .
Example of multiple line input . . . . .
Writing and editing text . . . . . . . . . .
Additional functions via the
PC interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Gigaset S685/S675 IP –
free software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
136
136
136
142
143
143
144
145
146
146
147
147
149
150
Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157
Glossary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
Mounting the charging cradle
to the wall, connecting the
charging cradle . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
Mounting the base station
to the wall . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
5
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / security.fm / 27.10.08
Safety precautions
Safety precautions
Warning:
Read the safety precautions and the user guide before use.
Explain their contents and the potential hazards associated with using the telephone to your children.
$
Only use the mains adapter supplied, as indicated on the underside of the base
station or charging cradle.
Only use the recommended, rechargeable batteries (page 145), i.e. never
use a conventional (non-rechargeable) battery or other battery types as this
could result in significant health risks and personal injury.
Batteries should not be disposed of in general household waste. Observe the
local waste disposal regulations, details of which can be obtained from your
local authority or the dealer you purchased the product from.
‹
Œ
Insert rechargeable batteries with the correct polarity, and use them in accordance with this user guide (polarity symbols can be seen in or on the handset's
battery compartment, page 10).
The operation of medical appliances may be affected. Be aware of the technical
conditions in your particular environment, e.g. doctor's surgery.
Do not hold the rear of the handset to your ear when it is ringing or when
the handsfree function is activated. Otherwise you risk serious and permanent
damage to your hearing.
The handset may cause an unpleasant humming noise in hearing aids.
Do not install the base station or charging cradle in bathrooms or shower rooms.
The handset, base station and charging cradle are not splashproof (page 136).
Do not use the phone in environments with a potential explosion hazard,
e.g. paint shops.
ƒ
If you give your Gigaset to someone else, make sure you also give them the user
guide.
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Please remove faulty base stations from use or have them repaired by our
service, as they could interfere with other wireless services.
6
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / security.fm / 27.10.08
Safety precautions
All electrical and electronic products should be disposed of separately from the
municipal waste stream via designated collection facilities appointed by the
government or the local authorities.
This crossed-out wheeled bin symbol on the product means the product is
covered by the European Directive 2002/96/EC.
The correct disposal and separate collection of your old appliance will help prevent potential negative consequences for the environment and human health.
It is a precondition for reuse and recycling of used electrical and electronic
equipment.
For more detailed information about disposal of your old appliance, please
contact your local council refuse centre or the original supplier of the product.
Warning:
When the keypad lock is active, you cannot call emergency numbers.
Please note:
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Not all of the functions described in this user guide are available in all countries.
7
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / starting.fm / 27.10.08
Gigaset S685/S675 IP – more than just a telephone
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Gigaset S685/S675 IP –
more than just a telephone
Your phone lets you make calls both via
the fixed line network and (cost effectively) via the Internet (VoIP) without
using a PC.
Your phone can do much more besides:
u Make calls with brilliant sound quality
(High Definition Sound Performance
HDSP, page 9) – for internal calls or
calls via VoIP.
u Press a button each time you make a
call to indicate whether you want to call
via the fixed line network or the Internet (page 26).
u Register up to six handsets on your
base station. With your base station,
you can simultaneously conduct two
calls via VoIP and one call via the fixed
line network.
u Multiline: Create up to six VoIP
accounts with different VoIP providers.
Together with your fixed line number
and the Gigaset.net number, your
phone can then be reached via up to
eight different phone numbers.
u Assign each handset its own VoIP
number as a send and receive number.
If a member of your family is called on
their VoIP number, only their handset
will ring (page 120).
u You can also use the VoIP accounts with
different providers for cost control purposes. When dialling, specify the VoIP
connection/the VoIP account you want
to use for its lower rates (page 27).
u Setting dialling plans for phone numbers or area codes enables you to automate the selection of the most costeffective VoIP connection (page 124).
u Determine which of your phone
numbers should be answered by the
Gigaset S675/S685 IP answer machine
(page 121).
u Use Gigaset.net for VoIP calls. Connect
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
your phone to the mains power supply
and the Internet, and enjoy free phone
calls on Gigaset.net – without making
any further settings (page 34).
Configure the phone connection for
VoIP without a PC. Your phone's connection assistant downloads general
data about your VoIP provider from the
Internet and guides you through entering your personal data (VoIP/SIP
account). This makes it easy for you to
start using VoIP (page 16).
If necessary, make any further VoIP settings on a PC. The phone features a
Web interface (Web configurator) that
can be accessed via your PC's Web
browser (page 104).
Use instant messaging on your handset. Go online and see which of your
messenger contacts (buddies) are also
online. Exchange SMS messages with
your buddies or simply give them a call
(page 71). A free messenger account is
already set up for you on the
Gigaset.net Jabber server (page 127).
Let your phone tell you, without
requiring a PC, about new e-mail messages in your mailbox (page 68). Use
your handset to delete old e-mail messages from your mailbox.
Make sure your phone is always up-todate. Keep yourself informed about
firmware updates on the Internet and
download them onto your phone
(page 98).
Reduce the transmission power of the
base station and handset. Activate eco
mode on your phone (page 20).
Use your Gigaset S68H handset for
wireless communication with other
Bluetooth devices using Bluetooth™
(e.g. headset, PDA, page 93).
Your Gigaset S685/S675 IP has a protected
operating system that offers increased security against viruses from the Internet.
Enjoy using your new phone!
8
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / starting.fm / 27.10.08
Version 4, 16.09.2005
VoIP – making calls via the Internet
VoIP – making calls via
the Internet
Gigaset HDSP – telephony
with brilliant sound quality
With VoIP (Voice over Internet Protocol),
your calls are not made via a fixed connection as in the telephone network, but
rather they are transmitted via the Internet in the form of data packets.
You can take advantage of all the benefits
of VoIP with your phone:
u You can make cost-effective calls in
high voice quality with callers on the
Internet, the fixed line network or the
mobile phone network.
u VoIP providers will give you personal
numbers, with which you can be
reached from the Internet, the fixed
line network and any mobile phone
network.
To be able to use VoIP, you need the
following:
u A broadband Internet connection
(e.g. DSL) with flat rate (recommended) or volume-based price.
u Internet access, i.e. you need a router
that will connect your phone to the
Internet.
You can find a list of recommended
routers on the Internet at:
www.gigaset.com/customercare
Here, go to the FAQ page and select
your Gigaset IP phone. Search for
"Router", for example.
u Access to the services of a VoIP provider. Open up to six accounts with different VoIP providers.
Your Gigaset IP
phone supports the
Broadband codec
G.722. With your
base station and the
corresponding handset, you can thus make calls via VoIP with
brilliant sound quality (High Definition
Sound Performance).
If you register further broadband-capable
handsets (e.g. Gigaset S67H, S68H or
SL37H) with your base station, internal
calls between these handsets will also be
conducted via broadband.
Preconditions for broadband connections
to your base station are:
u For internal calls:
Both handsets are broadband-capable,
i.e. both support codec G.722.
u For external calls via VoIP:
– You make the call from a broadbandcapable handset.
– You have selected codec G.722 for
outgoing calls (page 117).
– Your VoIP provider supports broadband connections.
– The recipient's phone supports
codec G.722 and accepts the establishment of a broadband connection.
Please note:
The VoIP service Gigaset.net (page 34)
supports broadband connections.
9
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / starting.fm / 27.10.08
First steps
First steps
Inserting the batteries
Warning:
Pack contents
The pack contains:
u one Gigaset S685/S675 IP base station
u one Gigaset S67H/S68H handset
u one mains adapter for the base station
u one charging cradle incl. mains adapter
u one phone cable
u one Ethernet cable (LAN cable)
u two batteries
u one battery cover
u one belt clip
u one quick guide
Only use rechargeable batteries (page 145)
recommended by Gigaset Communications
GmbH. Never use a conventional (nonrechargeable) battery or other battery types as
this could result in significant health risks and
personal injury. For example, the batteries
could explode. The phone could also malfunction or be damaged as a result of using batteries that are not of the recommended type.
¤ Insert the batteries the right way round
(see figure).
The polarity is indicated in/on the battery
compartment.
Firmware updates:
Your telephone is supplied with the firmware
version 097 or higher.
Whenever there are new or improved functions for your Gigaset IP phone, base station
firmware updates will be made available for
you to download to your telephone (page 98).
If this results in operational changes to your
phone, a new version of this user guide will be
published on the Internet at
www.gigaset.com
Setting up the handset for use
Version 4, 16.09.2005
The display is protected by a
plastic film. Please remove
the protective film!
The handset switches on automatically.
You will hear a confirmation tone.
Closing the battery cover
¤ First, align the notches on the side of
¤
the battery cover with the protrusions
on the inside of the housing.
Then press the cover until it clicks into
place.
Opening the battery cover
¤ If fitted, remove the belt clip.
* Gigaset Communications GmbH is a trademark licensee of Siemens AG.
10
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / starting.fm / 27.10.08
First steps
¤ Place your fingertip in the cavity on the
casing and pull the battery cover
upwards.
¤ Once the batteries are fully charged,
remove the handset from the charging
cradle and do not put it back again until
the batteries are fully discharged.
Please note:
After the first battery charge and discharge,
you may place your handset in the charging
cradle after every call.
Please note:
u Always repeat the charging and dis-
Connecting the charging cradle
The charging cradle is designed to be
operated in enclosed, dry areas at temperatures ranging from +5 °C to +45 °C.
Instructions on how to connect the charging cradle and mount it on the wall (if
required) can be found on page 183.
¤ To charge the batteries, leave the handset in the charging cradle.
Please note:
– Only place the handset in the charging cradle that is intended for it.
– If the handset has turned itself off because
the batteries are flat and is then placed in
the charging cradle, it will turn itself on
automatically.
For questions and problems see page 136.
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Initial charging and discharging of
batteries
If the handset is activated, the flashing
battery icon e in the top right of the display indicates that the batteries are being
charged.
During handset operation, the battery
icon indicates the charge status of the batteries (page 1).
The correct charge status can only be displayed if the batteries are first fully
charged and discharged through use.
¤ To do this, leave the handset in the
charging cradle without interruption
until the battery icon stops flashing in
the display (around 10 hours).
charging procedure if you remove the
batteries from the handset and reinsert
them.
u The batteries may warm up during
charging. This is not dangerous.
u After a while the charge capacity of the
batteries will decrease for technical reasons.
Please note:
You will find explanations for the symbols and
typographical conventions used in this user
guide in the appendix, page 146.
Setting the date and time
The date and time must be set in order to
have the correct time for incoming calls
and to be able to use the alarm clock and
calendar.
Please note:
The address of a time server on the Internet is
stored on your telephone. The date and time
are taken from this time server provided that
the base station is connected to the Internet
and synchronisation with the time server is
activated (page 134). Manual settings are
overwritten in this case.
If the date and time on the phone have not
yet been set, the §Time§ display key will
appear.
11
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / starting.fm / 27.10.08
First steps
Manual setting:
You can use the menu at a later point to
enter the date and time.
¤ Press §Time§ or open the v ¢ ¢ Date/Time menu.
¤ Change multiple line input:
Date:
Enter the day, month and year in 8-digit
format, e.g. Q M Q QQN for 07/01/2008.
Time:
Enter hours and minutes as 4 digits,
e.g. Q M for 07:15 a.m.
§Save§
Press the display key
The date and time are shown in the handset's idle display (page 1).
Registering the handset to the base
station
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Your handset is registered to the base station by default.
Instructions on how to register additional
handsets with the base station and make
free internal calls can be found from
page 81.
12
Installing the base station
The base station is designed for use in
closed, dry rooms with a temperature
range of +5 °C to +45 °C.
¤ Place or hang the base station in a central position in your flat or house.
Instructions for mounting the base station
on the wall can be found on page 184.
Please note:
u Never expose the telephone to heat
sources, direct sunlight or other electrical appliances.
u Protect your Gigaset from moisture,
dust, corrosive liquids and vapours.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / starting.fm / 27.10.08
First steps
Connecting the base station
In order to be able to make calls with your
phone via the fixed line network and via
VoIP, you must connect the base station
to the fixed line and the Internet.
4
3
1
2
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Figure 1 Connecting the phone to the fixed line and the Internet
13
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / starting.fm / 27.10.08
First steps
Follow the steps in the order given below:
1. Connect the phone cord and power
lead to the base station.
2. Connect the base station to the fixed
line network and the mains power supply.
3. To connect the base station to the Internet, first connect the base station to
the router (connection via router and
modem or via router with integrated
modem).
4. Connect the PC and router (optional) for advanced configuration of the base
station (see page 104).
1. Connect the phone cord and power
lead to the base station
2. Connect the base station to the fixed
line network and the mains power
supply
1
2
1. Insert the phone cord into the fixed line
network connection socket.
2. Then insert the mains adapter into the
mains socket.
Please note:
2
u Keep the mains adapter plugged in at
1
3
1. Insert the phone cord into the lower
connection socket at the rear of the
base station.
2. Insert the power lead of the mains
adapter into the upper connection
socket at the rear of the base station.
3. Push both cables into the appropriate
cable channels.
all times for operation, as the phone
does not work without mains connection.
u Only use the mains adapter and phone
cord supplied.
u If you buy a replacement phone cord
from a retailer, pay attention to the wiring of the phone jack.
Correct phone jack assignment
3
2
1
4
5
6
1
2
3
4
5
6
unused
unused
a
b
unused
unused
Version 4, 16.09.2005
You can now use your phone to make calls
via the fixed line network and can be
reached on your fixed line number.
Your answer machine is set with a default
announcement in answer and record mode
(page 61).
14
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / starting.fm / 27.10.08
First steps
3. Connect the base station to the
router (Internet)
For Internet access you need a router connected to the Internet via a modem (this
may be integrated in the router).
2
1
1. Connect an Ethernet cable plug into
the LAN socket at the side of the base
station.
2. Then insert the second Ethernet cable
plug into a LAN socket on the router.
As soon as the cable connecting the
phone and router is plugged in and the
router is turned on, the key lights up on the
front of the base station (paging key).
Making settings for VoIP
telephony
Before you can use the Internet (VoIP) to
phone any other numbers on the Internet,
the fixed line network or the mobile
phone network, you need the services of a
VoIP provider who supports the VoIP SIP
standard.
Precondition: You have registered with
such a VoIP provider (e.g. via your PC) and
set up at least one VoIP account.
The following phone settings are necessary in order for you to use VoIP. You can
obtain the following information from
your VoIP provider:
u Your user name with the VoIP provider,
if this is required by the VoIP provider
u Your registration name
u Your password with the VoIP provider
u VoIP provider general settings
The connection assistant will help you
with the settings.
Automatic configuration:
If your provider supports "automatic configuration", you will receive an "auto configuration
code" from your provider instead of an authentication name and password.
You will need to set the VoIP configuration
with the auto configuration code via the Web
configurator on the base station (see page 104
"Connecting PC with Web configurator" and
page 111 "Configuring the VoIP connection")
Version 4, 16.09.2005
You can now establish VoIP connections
within Gigaset.net (page 34).
15
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / starting.fm / 27.10.08
First steps
Starting the connection assistant
Precondition: The base station is connected to the mains power supply and a
router. Your router is connected to the
Internet (page 15).
Tip: Leave VoIP activated as the default
connection for your telephone (default
setting, page 98). The telephone then
attempts to establish a connection directly
to your VoIP provider's server after the
connection assistant is closed. If incorrect/
incomplete information means that the
connection cannot be established, messages will be displayed (page 18).
Please note:
Your phone is preconfigured for dynamic
assignment of the IP address. In order for your
router to "recognise" the phone, dynamic IP
address assignment must also be activated on
the router, i.e. the router's DHCP server is activated. Turn to page 101 to find out how to
assign your phone a static IP address if necessary.
As soon as the handset battery is sufficiently charged, the message key on
the handset will flash (approx. 20 minutes
after you have put the handset in the
charging cradle). Press the message key
to start the connection assistant.
You will see the following display:
Connection Assist.
Start assistant
for entry of VoIP
connection data?
No
Press the display key to start
the connection assistant.
Enter the system PIN (default
is 0000) and press §OK§.
If you press §No§,the procedure that follows
is described under "Entering your name in
the Gigaset.net directory" on page 17.
§Yes§
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Yes
16
Please note:
The connection assistant will also start automatically if you try to establish a connection
via the Internet before you have made the necessary settings.
You can also call up the connection assistant at
any time via the menu (page 99).
Downloading VoIP provider data
The phone establishes a connection with
the Gigaset server on the Internet. Various
profiles with general access data for different VoIP providers can be downloaded
here.
After a brief period you will see the following display:
Select Country
Germany
England
France
Netherlands, the
:
:
OK
Select country (press up/down
on the control key) and press
§OK§. VoIP providers for which
VoIP profiles are available will
be displayed.
Select your VoIP provider and
press §OK§.
The necessary general access data for your
VoIP provider will be downloaded and
saved on the phone.
If the data for your VoIP provider is not available for download, press the display key
twice. You can then carry out the following
steps with the connection assistant.
You must then make the required VoIP provider settings using the Web configurator
(page 111). Your VoIP provider will supply you
with this data.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / starting.fm / 27.10.08
First steps
Entering user data for your first VoIP
account
Entering your name in the Gigaset.net
directory
Enter the VoIP user data for the first VoIP
account. Your VoIP provider will supply
you with this data.
With Gigaset.net you can call other
Gigaset.net users directly over the Internet
free of charge, without setting up an
account with a VoIP provider and without
making any further settings. You can find
Gigaset.net subscribers by carrying out a
name search in the Gigaset.net directory
(page 34).
The following appears in the handset's display:
You can enter five additional VoIP accounts
(VoIP phone numbers) via the Web configurator at a later stage (page 110). Your phone
(together with your fixed line number) can
then be reached on up to seven different
phone numbers. You can assign the phone
numbers to the individual handsets that are
registered with the base station as send and
receive numbers (page 120).
Connection Assist.
Username:
Enter the user name and press
Start assistant
for Gigaset.net?
§OK§ if this is required by your
provider.
Authent. Name:
Enter the registration name
and press §OK§.
Authent. Password:
Enter password and press §OK§.
Please note:
When making these entries, please remember
the VoIP user data is case sensitive. When you
enter text, the first letter is capitalised by
default. If necessary, press and hold the key to switch between upper and lower case
and numbers.
Version 4, 16.09.2005
If you have made all the required entries,
the message "Connection data complete" will
appear on the display.
Then the Gigaset.net assistant is started.
No
Yes
§Yes§
Press the display key.
Enter your Gigaset.net name:
Enter the name that you
would like to be listed under in
the Gigaset.net directory and
press §OK§. The name may contain up to 25 characters.
A connection to the Gigaset.net server is
established.
If there is already an entry under this
name, you will receive a message to this
effect and you will be asked to enter a
name again.
If an entry in the Gigaset.net directory is
successful, the message "Your user name is
successfully added to Gigaset.net!" is displayed briefly.
If the attempt to create the entry fails (e.g.
because the phone is not connected to the
Internet), a message to this effect is displayed
briefly (see page 18). You can then create the
entry later via the Gigaset.net directory (see
page 36).
17
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / starting.fm / 27.10.08
First steps
Completing the VoIP settings
No connection to the Internet/VoIP server
After the entries have been completed,
the handset reverts to idle status.
If all the settings are correct and if the
phone can establish a connection to the
VoIP server, then the internal name of the
handset will be displayed (example):
If one of the following messages is displayed instead of the internal name after
the connection assistant is closed, errors
have occurred:
u Server not accessible!
u Provider registration failed!
Below you will find possible causes and
measures you can take.
Ð
V
Server not accessible!
INT 1
15.01.08
?
09:45
SMS
You can now use your phone to make calls
via the fixed line network and the Internet.
Callers can reach you on your fixed line
number and your VoIP number.
Please note:
Version 4, 16.09.2005
– To ensure that you can always be reached
via the Internet, the router must be permanently connected to the Internet.
– If you try to make a call via a VoIP connection that is not configured correctly, the following VoIP status message will appear on
the display: IP configuration error: xxx or VoIP
config. error: xxx (xxx = VoIP status code).
The various status codes and their respective meanings can be found in the appendix on page 140.
18
The phone has no connection to the Internet.
¤ Check the cable connection between
the base station and the router (the
LED on the base station must light up)
and the connection between the router
and the Internet connection.
¤ Check whether the phone is connected
to the LAN.
– It may not have been possible to
dynamically assign an IP address to
the phone
or
– You have assigned a static IP address
to the phone that has either already
been assigned to another LAN subscriber or does not belong to the
router's address block.
¤ Press the paging key on the base station. The IP address appears on the
handset display.
¤ Press the talk key on the handset to
end paging call.
¤ Start the Web configurator with the
IP address.
¤ If no connection can be established,
change the settings on the router
(activate DHCP server) or the
phone's IP address.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / starting.fm / 27.10.08
First steps
Provider registration failed!
u Your personal data for registering with
the VoIP provider may have been
entered incompletely or incorrectly.
¤ Check your entries for Username,
Authent. Name and Authent. Password.
In particular, check your use of
upper and lower case.
To do this, open the following menu
on your handset:
v ¢ ¢ Telephony ¢ VoIP
(enter system PIN) ¢ Provider Registr. (see page 100)
u The server address for the VoIP server
has not yet been entered, or has been
entered incorrectly.
¤ Start the Web configurator.
¤ Open the following Web page:
Settings ¢ Telephony
¢ Connections.
¤ Click the Edit button next to the first
VoIP connection.
¤ Edit the server address where necessary.
If port forwarding is activated on your router
for the ports that have been registered as the
SIP port (Standard 5060) and the RTP port
(Standard 5004), it is advisable to deactivate
DHCP and assign the phone a static IP address
(otherwise you may not be able to hear the
other party during VoIP calls):
– Assign IP address via the handset menu:
v
Base
Local Network
Or
– Assign IP address via the Web configurator:
Open the following Web page:
Settings
IP Configuration.
Select IP address type.
Please note that the IP address and subnet
mask depend on the router's address block.
You must also enter the standard gateway and
DNS server. The IP address for the router is
generally entered here.
£ £
Version 4, 16.09.2005
By using a belt clip and headset (optional)
you can easily make your handset a constant companion both inside the building
and in its immediate vicinity.
Attaching the belt clip
There are notches for attaching the belt
clip on both sides of the handset at the top
and at the same height as the display.
¤ Press the belt clip onto the back of the
handset so that the protrusions on the
belt clip engage with the notches.
Connection socket for headset
Please note:
¥
¥
Belt clip and headset
£
You can connect various headset types
(with 2.5 mm jack connector), including
HAMA Plantronics M40, MX100 and
MX150.
A compatibility list of tested headsets is
available on the Internet at:
www.plantronics.com/productfinder
£
19
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / starting.fm / 27.10.08
ECO DECT: reducing the transmission power and power consumption
ECO DECT:
reducing the transmission
power and power
consumption
The base station of your phone is an ECO
DECT base station, this means that:
u The base station uses less power
because it is equipped with a powersaving mains adaptor.
u The reduction of the handset's transmission power is dependent on the
handset's proximity to the base station.
u The base station can also be switched
to eco mode. Eco mode reduces the
transmission power and power consumption of the base station. This can
be set on your handset.
Activating/deactivating eco mode
Precondition: Repeater support must be
deactivated.
v ¢ ¢ Base ¢ Add. Features
Eco Mode Select and press §OK§ ( ‰ = on).
Eco mode enables an additional reduction
in the transmission power of the Gigaset
S67H/S68H handset. If, with Eco mode
activated, the transmission power of both
the base station and the handset is
reduced, the ½ icon is shown in the top
line of the display.
Please note:
Version 4, 16.09.2005
– Activating eco mode reduces the range of
the base station.
– Eco mode and repeater support cancel each
other out, i.e. both functions cannot be
used at the same time.
20
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / menuetree.fm / 27.10.08
Menu trees
Menu trees
Phone menu
Open the main menu on your phone by right-clicking the control key when the handset is
in idle status: v.
There are two ways to select a function:
Using number combinations (shortcut)
¤ Enter the number combination that is in front of the function in the menu tree.
Example: v N for "Set handset language".
Scrolling through the menus
¤ In the main menu: navigate to the function using the control key (press up/
down or left/right) and press §OK§.
¤ In the submenus: scroll to the function with the control key (press up or down) and
press §OK§.
1
Messaging
1-1 SMS
An SMS mailbox (general or private) activated
without a PIN
page 53
1-1-1
New SMS
page 54
1-1-2
Incoming (0)
page 55
1-1-3
Outgoing (0)
page 54
An SMS mailbox activated with a PIN or 2-3 mailboxes
1-1-1
Version 4, 16.09.2005
1-1-2
to
1-1-4
Mailbox
Mailbox 1
Mailbox 2
Mailbox 3
1-1-1-1 New SMS
page 54
1-1-1-2 Incoming (0)
page 55
1-1-1-3 Outgoing (0)
page 54
1-1-2-1 New SMS
to
1-1-4-1
page 54
1-1-2-2 Incoming (0)
to
1-1-4-2
page 55
1-1-2-3 Outgoing (0)
to
1-1-4-3
page 54
21
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / menuetree.fm / 27.10.08
Menu trees
1-1-6
Settings
1-1-6-1 Service Centres
page 58
1-1-6-2 SMS Mailboxes
page 58
1-1-6-3 Notify Number
page 57
1-1-6-4 Notify Type
page 57
1-1-6-6 Subscribe to SMS
page 53
1-2 E-mail
1-3 Messenger
2
page 68
1-3-1
Buddies
1-3-2
User Status
1-3-2-1 Change Status
page 73
1-3-2-2 Info
page 73
1-3-3
Messages
page 75
2-1-6
Call Divert
page 39
2-1-7
Call Waiting
page 39
2-2-6
Call Divert
page 37
2-2-7
Call Waiting
page 38
Sel. Services
2-1 VoIP
2-2 Fixed Line
2-3 Ringback Off
page 39
2-4 Always anon.
page 37
2-5 Next Call
page 37
3
Calls List
4
Add. Features
4-3 Room Monitor
4-4 Data Transfer
4-6 Missed Alarms
Version 4, 16.09.2005
page 74
page 84
4-4-2
Bluetooth
page 94
4-4-3
Directory
page 43
page 93
5
Alarm Clock
page 91
6
Calendar
page 92
22
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / menuetree.fm / 27.10.08
Menu trees
7
Resource Dir.
7-1 Screensavers
page 91
7-2 Caller Pictures
page 91
7-3 Sounds
page 91
7-4 Capacity
page 91
8
Settings
8-1 Date/Time
8-2 Audio Settings
page 11
8-2-1
Handset Volume
8-2-2
Ringer Settings
8-2-2-1 Ext. Calls
page 89
8-2-2-2 Internal Calls
8-2-2-3 Appointments
8-2-2-4 All
8-3 Display
8-4 Handset
8-5 Base
8-2-3
Advisory Tones
page 90
8-3-1
Screen Saver
page 86
8-3-2
Colour Scheme
page 86
8-3-3
Contrast
page 86
8-3-4
Backlight
page 87
8-4-1
Language
page 86
8-4-2
Auto Answer
page 88
8-4-3
Register H/Set
page 81
8-4-4
Select Base
page 82
8-4-5
Area Codes
page 95
8-4-6
Reset Handset
page 96
8-5-1
Calls List Type
8-5-1-1 Missed Calls
page 49
Version 4, 16.09.2005
8-5-1-2 All Calls
8-5-2
Music on hold
page 97
8-5-3
System PIN
page 96
8-5-4
Base Reset
page 97
8-5-5
Add. Features
8-5-5-1 Repeater Mode
page 98
8-5-5-3 Eco Mode
page 20
8-5-6
Local Network
page 101
8-5-8
Software Update
page 98
23
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / menuetree.fm / 27.10.08
Menu trees
8-6 Voice Mail
8-6-1
8-6-2
Local AM
Network AM(s)
8-6-1-1 Ans Machine
page 61
8-6-1-2 Call Screening
page 65
8-6-1-3 Announcements
page 62
8-6-1-4 Message Length
page 66
8-6-1-5 Record Quality
page 66
8-6-1-6 Ring Delay
page 65
8-6-2-1 Net AM: Fxd. line
page 78
8-6-2-2 Net AM: IP1
:
(dependent on the number of configured
VoIP phone numbers and receive numbers
on the handset)
8-6-2-7 Net AM: IP6
8-6-3
Set Key 1
Local AM
page 66
Net AM: Fxd. line
page 79
Net AM: IP1
:
(dependent on the number of configured
VoIP phone numbers and receive numbers
on the handset)
Net AM: IP6
8-7 Telephony
8-7-1
Default Line
8-7-1-1 VoIP
page 98
8-7-1-2 Fixed Line
8-7-2
Connection Assist.
8-7-6
Fixed Line
Version 4, 16.09.2005
8-7-7
24
VoIP
page 99
8-7-6-1 Dialling Mode
page 102
8-7-6-2 Recall
page 102
Enter
system
PIN.
Show Stat. on HS
page 102
Select Provider
page 100
Provider Registr.
page 100
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / menuetree.fm / 27.10.08
Menu trees
Web configurator menu
page 104
Home
Settings
IP Configuration
page 109
Telephony
Connections
page 110
Audio
page 117
Number Assignment
page 120
Call Forwarding
page 121
Dialling Plans
page 124
Network Mailbox
page 126
Advanced Settings
page 122
Messenger
page 126
E-Mail
page 128
Messaging
Services
page 128/page 129
Handsets
page 130/page 130
Miscellaneous
page 132 to page 132
Device
page 135
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Status
25
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / telephony.fm / 27.10.08
Making calls with VoIP and the fixed line network
Making calls with VoIP and
the fixed line network
Making an external call
External calls are calls made via the public
telephone network (fixed line network) or
via the Internet (VoIP). You generally
decide which connection type you want to
use for a specific call when you dial the
number.
Please note:
– You can conduct up to three separate external calls via your base station (using different handsets): two calls via VoIP and one
via the fixed line network.
– You can define dialling plans for certain
numbers or area codes by determining the
connection and therefore the billing
method to be used (cost control, see
page 124) when these numbers are dialled.
– Dialling with the directory (page 41), quick
dial keys (page 87) or last number redial list
(page 48) saves repeated keying of phone
numbers. You can modify or add to these
numbers on a call-to-call basis.
– If you use VoIP to make a call to the fixed
line network, you may also have to dial the
area code for local calls (depending on the
VoIP provider). You can avoid having to dial
your own area code by entering it into the
configuration (page 123). Your area code is
then added automatically when you make
local calls.
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Use the talk key to select the type of
connection and make the call
By briefly pressing or pressing and holding
the call key , you can determine the
type of connection for the call you want to
make (fixed line network or VoIP).
Precondition: You enter the number without a line suffix (page 27) and have not
defined any dialling plans for this number.
Enter number (without suffix)
and briefly press/press and
hold the talk key.
26
A default connection is established on
your phone (fixed line network or VoIP,
page 98/page 119).
¤ Briefly press the talk key if you
want to make a call via this default connection.
¤ Press and hold the talk key if you
want to make the call via the other connection type.
If you have assigned a number of VoIP
numbers to your phone, you can define
which VoIP number (VoIP account) is used
for external calls from each specific handset (handset send number, page 120).
Please note:
If you are using a GAP compatible handset
other than the Gigaset handsets C47H, S67H,
S68H, SL37H, S45 and C45, every call will be
made via the standard connection, even if you
press and hold the talk key. If you want to use
the non-default connection to make a call,
enter a star (*) at the end of the number.
Selecting the connection type using
display keys and making a call
Precondition: The display keys on your
handset have been assigned §FixedLine§ and/
or §IP§ (page 87).
§FixedLine§ / §IP§
Press the display key to select
the connection type.
Enter the number or select
from the directory.
/ Press the talk or handsfree key.
The number will always be called via the
selected connection type.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / telephony.fm / 27.10.08
Making calls with VoIP and the fixed line network
Please note:
If you have pressed the §IP§ before dialling and
...
– ... dialled the number with suffix #1 to #6,
your call will be made via the VoIP account
assigned to the suffix. The number will not
be dialled if the suffix is invalid (e.g. no VoIP
connection assigned).
– ... dialled the number without a suffix or
with the suffix #0, your call will be made via
the handset's VoIP send number.
Do not enter a suffix if you have pressed the
display key §FixedLine§ prior to dialling. Otherwise the suffix will be dialled together with the
number via the fixed line network. This may
cause errors!
Select and dial a connection via your line
suffix
Version 4, 16.09.2005
You can configure up to six VoIP numbers
on your phone in addition to the fixed line
network number and the Gigaset.net
number. A (line) suffix is assigned to each
number (line) of your phone:
u the fixed line number has the suffix #0
u VoIP numbers have the suffixes #1 to
#6 (page 111)
u the Gigaset.net number has the suffix
#9
When dialling, you can use this line suffix
to specify the connection via which you
would like to call or be charged.
Enter the number of the party
you wish to call.
Add the suffix for the connection (your phone number)
through which you wish to
make and pay for the call.
Press the talk key.
The connection is always made via the line
with the assigned suffix, regardless of
whether you press the call key briefly
or press and hold.
Example: If you enter the number
1234567890#1 and press the talk key
, the number 1234567890 will be
dialled via the first VoIP connection in the
configuration.
Please note:
If you specify a suffix for which no VoIP connection is configured in your base station, the
VoIP status code 0x33 will be displayed. The
number will not be dialled.
Entering an IP address
You can also dial an IP address instead of a
phone number using VoIP.
¤ Press the star key to separate the
sections of the IP address
(e.g. 149*246*122*28).
¤ If necessary press the hash key to
attach the SIP port number of the person you are calling to the IP address
(e.g. 149*246*122*28#5060).
You cannot dial IP addresses using a line
suffix.
Cancelling the dialling operation
You can cancel the dialling operation with
the end call key .
Gigaset S68H: Continuing a call on a
Bluetooth headset
Precondition: Bluetooth is activated; a
connection has been established between
the Bluetooth headset and the handset
(page 94).
Press the talk key on the Bluetooth headset; it may take up to 5 seconds to establish a connection to the handset.
For further details about your headset, see
the user guide issued with it.
27
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / telephony.fm / 27.10.08
Making calls with VoIP and the fixed line network
Dialling emergency numbers –
defining dialling plans
You can use the Web configurator to block
certain numbers or to define which of
your numbers (fixed line network, VoIP)
should be used to call specific numbers
(Dialling Plans, see page 124).
If you enter a number that has a defined
dialling plan, the call will be made via the
line defined in the dialling plan – regardless of whether the talk key is pressed
briefly or pressed and held. Any automatic
area code will not be prefixed to the
number.
Emergency numbers
Dialling plans for emergency numbers
(e.g. the local emergency service
number) are factory-set for certain countries. Emergency calls are then always
made via the fixed line network.
You cannot delete or deactivate these dialling plans. However, you can change the
connection through which each emergency number should be called (e.g. if the
phone is not connected to the fixed line
network). You must make sure that the
VoIP provider for the selected connection
supports emergency calls.
If your phone does not have default dialling plans for emergency calls, you should
define the rules yourself (page 124).
Assign them to a connection that you
know supports emergency calls. Emergency calls are always supported by fixed
line networks.
Please note: If no rules are defined for
emergency numbers and you have programmed an automatic local area code
(page 123), the code will be prefixed to
emergency numbers as soon as they are
dialled via a VoIP connection.
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Please note:
Emergency numbers cannot be dialled if the
keypad lock is activated. Before dialling, press
and hold the hash key , to release the
keypad lock.
28
Ending a call
Press the end call key.
Accepting a call
The handset indicates an incoming call in
three ways: by ringing, by a display on the
screen and by the flashing handsfree key
.
Please note:
Only calls to receive numbers assigned to your
handset will be signalled (page 120).
Calls made to a number that is not assigned to
a handset as a receive number will not be signalled on any handset.
You can accept the call by:
¤ Pressing the talk key .
¤ Pressing the handsfree key .
¤ Pressing the display key Ÿ to forward the call to the answer machine
(page 65).
If the handset is in the charging cradle and
the Auto Answer function is activated
(page 88), the handset will take a call
automatically when you lift it out of the
cradle.
If the ringer tone is intrusive, press the
§Silence§ display key. You can accept the call
so long as it is displayed on the screen.
Please note:
You can reject VoIP calls by pressing the end
call key . The caller receives an appropriate
message.
Pressing the end call key on an incoming call
from the fixed line network will cancel the
ringer tone (same as §Silence§).
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / telephony.fm / 27.10.08
Making calls with VoIP and the fixed line network
Gigaset S68H:
Accepting a call on a Bluetooth headset
Precondition: Bluetooth is activated; a
connection has been established between
the Bluetooth headset and the handset
(see page 94).
Only when the headset rings: Press the
talk key on the headset. It may take up to
5 seconds to establish a connection to the
handset.
For further details about your headset, see
the user guide issued with it.
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Calling Line Identification
When you receive a call from the Internet,
the caller's number and/or the name they
have specified is displayed on the screen.
When you receive a call from the fixed line
network, the caller's number is displayed
on the screen if the following conditions
are met:
u Your fixed line network provider supports CLIP, CLI:
– CLI (Calling Line Identification):
number of the caller is transmitted
– CLIP (Calling Line Identification Presentation): the caller's number is displayed
u You have arranged CLIP with your network provider.
u The caller has arranged CLI with the
network provider.
If the phone number is identified and the
caller's number is saved in your handset's
local directory, the name will be displayed
from the directory. A CLIP image allocated
to the name will also appear in the display.
If the caller's phone number is not saved in
the local directory the caller's surname
and first name will be displayed from the
currently active online directory.
Precondition: You have activated this
option (see Web configurator page 129).
Call display
You can use the display to determine
whether the call is for your fixed line network number or one of your VoIP numbers.
Calls to your fixed line number
1
1234567890
for Fixed Line
×
2
3
Silence
1 Ringer icon or the CLIP picture assigned to
the caller (page 42)
2 Number or name of caller
3 Display of the receive number: The name is
displayed that you have assigned to your
fixed line network number (page 116).
Calls to your VoIP number
1
IP: 1234567890
for Anna
×
2
3
Silence
1 Ringer icon or the CLIP picture assigned to
the caller (page 42)
2 Number or name of caller
3 Receive number: Indicates which of your
VoIP phone numbers the caller has dialled.
You assign the names when you enter the
VoIP phone numbers into the phone
(page 112). For calls from Gigaset.net, for
Gigaset.net is displayed.
29
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / telephony.fm / 27.10.08
Making calls with VoIP and the fixed line network
Adopting the name from the online
directory
You can display the name under which the
caller is saved in the online directory.
Preconditions:
u The provider of the online directory you
have set for your telephone (page 129)
supports this function.
u You have activated the "display caller
name" function via the Web configurator (page 129).
u The caller has authorised Calling Line
Identification and has not suppressed
the function.
u Your telephone is connected to the
Internet.
u The caller's number is not saved in the
handset's local directory.
Net Dir.
Anna Magdalena
Sand
1
2
Silence
1 Name of the currently active online directory from which the name was obtained
2 Name of the caller, possibly over a number
of lines
The number is displayed if the caller's name
is in neither the local directory nor the online directory.
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Display when Calling Line Identification is
withheld
The caller's name and/or number will not
be displayed if the caller has suppressed
Calling Line Identification:
u VoIP: The caller has activated the
"anonymous calling" function.
u Fixed line network: The caller has activated the "anonymous calling" function
or has suppressed Calling Line Identification from the fixed line network provider.
30
IP:Unavailable
Anonymous
for IP1
×
Silence
u For calls to your fixed line network
numbers:
– External, if no number is transmitted.
– Withheld, if the caller has withheld
Calling Line Identification.
– Unavailable, if the caller has not
arranged Calling Line Identification.
VoIP: Displaying the called party's
phone number (COLP)
Preconditions:
for Anna
×
The following is displayed in place of the
number:
u For calls to one of your VoIP numbers
(example):
u Your VoIP provider supports COLP (Con-
nected Line Identification Presentation). You may have to ask your provider to activate COLP (contact your
VoIP provider for more information).
u The called party has not activated COLR
(Connected Line Identification Restriction).
For outgoing VoIP calls, the phone
number of the connection on which the
call is received is displayed on the handset.
The displayed number may differ from the
number you have dialled. Examples:
u The called party has activated call forwarding.
u The call is answered by another connection within a PABX system.
If there is an entry in the directory for this
phone number, the corresponding name
will be displayed.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / telephony.fm / 27.10.08
Operating the handset
Muting the handset
Please note:
– The number of the connection you have
reached (or the assigned name) will also be
displayed instead of the called number during toggling, conference calls and consultation calls.
– When the phone number is copied to the
directory (§Options§
Copy to Directory) and
the last number redial list, the dialled
number (not the displayed number) is copied.
£
Handsfree talking
In handsfree mode, instead of holding the
handset to your ear you can put it down,
for example on the table in front of you.
This allows others to participate in the call.
Activating/deactivating handsfree
mode
Activating while dialling
¤
Enter number and press
briefly/press and hold the
handsfree key to select the
connection type (page 26).
You should inform your caller before
you use the handsfree function so that
they know someone else is listening.
Switching between earpiece and
handsfree mode
Version 4, 16.09.2005
¤ Press the handsfree key to activate/
deactivate handsfree talking during a
call and when listening to the answer
machine of a Gigaset S675/S685 IP.
If you wish to place the handset in the
charging cradle during a call:
¤ Press and hold the handsfree key while placing the handset in the charging cradle.
¤ If the handsfree key does not light
up, press the key again.
For how to adjust the loudspeaker volume, see page 88.
You can deactivate the microphone in
your handset during an external call. Your
caller will hear hold music, if activated
(page 97).
Muting the handset
Press the control key on the
left to mute the handset.
Cancelling muting
/ Press the display key or the
end call key to cancel the muting.
Operating the handset
Activating/deactivating the
handset
In idle status, press and hold
the end call key.
You will hear the confirmation tone.
Activating/deactivating the
keypad lock
Press and hold the hash key.
You will hear the confirmation tone. The
Ø icon appears in the display when the
keypad lock is activated.
The keypad lock deactivates automatically
when you receive a call and activates
again after the call.
Please note:
The handset displays an advisory message if
you press a key by accident while the keypad
lock is on. To deactivate the keypad lock, press
and hold the hash key .
31
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / telephony.fm / 27.10.08
Operating the handset
Control key
In this user guide, the side/position of the
control key that you must press in the
given operating situation is shown in
black (top, bottom, right, left). Example:
for "press up on the control key".
The control key has a number of different
functions:
When the handset is in idle status
v
Press briefly to open the handset directory.
Press and hold to open the list
of available online directories.
Open the main menu.
Open the list of handsets.
Call up the menu for setting
the handset's call volume
(page 88), ringer tones
(page 89) and advisory tones
(page 90).
In the main menu and in input fields
You can use the control key to move the
cursor up , down , right v or
left .
In lists and submenus
Version 4, 16.09.2005
/ v
32
Scroll up/down line by line.
Open the submenu.
Go back one menu level or
cancel.
During an external call
Briefly press to open the handset directory.
Press and hold to open the
Gigaset.net directory).
Initiate an internal consultation call.
Adjust the loudspeaker volume for earpiece and handsfree mode.
Display keys
The current display functions are shown in
the bottom display line and are reversedhighlighted. The function of the display
keys changes depending on the particular
operating situation.
Example:
?
SMS
1
2
1 Current display key functions are shown in
the bottom display line.
2 Display keys
The most important display icons are:
Left display key, as long as it
has not been assigned a function (page 87).
§Options§
Open a situation-dependent
menu (context menu).
W
Delete key: deletes one character at a time from right to
left.
Î
Go back one menu level or
cancel operation.
Fetch e-mail address from the
directory.
Copy number into directory.
Ÿ
Forward external call to
answer machine.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / telephony.fm / 27.10.08
Operating the handset
Reverting to idle status
You can revert to idle status from anywhere in the menu as follows:
¤ Press and hold the end call key .
Or:
¤ Do not press any key: after 2 minutes
the display will automatically revert to
idle status.
Changes that you have not confirmed or
saved by pressing §OK§, §Yes§, §Save§, §Send§ or
Save Entry §OK§ will be lost.
You can find an example of the display in
idle status on page 1.
Menu guidance
Your telephone's functions are accessed
using a menu that has a number of levels.
Main menu (first menu level)
¤ To open the main menu, press v with
the handset in idle status.
The main menu functions are shown in
the display as a list with colour icons.
Accessing a function
¤ Navigate to the function using the con-
Version 4, 16.09.2005
trol key /. The name of the function is displayed in the display header.
Press the display key §OK§.
Or:
¤ Enter the number that is in front of the
function in the menu tree (page 21)
(shortcut).
The corresponding submenu (the next
menu level) is opened.
Submenus
The functions in the submenus are displayed as lists.
To access a function:
¤ Scroll to the function with the control
key and press §OK§.
Or:
¤ Enter the number combination that is
in front of the function in the menu
tree (page 21) (shortcut).
Briefly press the end call key once to
return to the previous menu level/cancel
the operation.
Correcting incorrect entries
You can correct incorrect characters in the
text by navigating to the incorrect entry
using the control key. You can then:
u Press X to delete the character to the
left of the cursor.
u Insert a new character to the left of the
cursor.
u Overwrite the flashing character when
entering time and date, IP addresses
etc.
You will find examples of icons used,
menu entries and multiple line input in the
appendix to this user guide, page 146.
33
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / telephony.fm / 27.10.08
VoIP telephony via Gigaset.net
VoIP telephony via
Gigaset.net
You can use Gigaset.net to make free
phone calls via the Internet directly to
other Gigaset.net users, without having to
set up an account with a VoIP provider or
make any further settings. You simply
have to connect your phone to the power
supply and the Internet connection and, if
necessary, enter yourself in the
Gigaset.net online directory under a name
of your choice (page 17/page 36).
Gigaset net is a VoIP service provided by
Gigaset Communications GmbH, which is
available to all users with a Gigaset VoIP
device.
You can call other subscribers to
Gigaset.net free of charge, i.e. there are
no telephone charges other than the costs
for your Internet connection. Connections
to/from other networks are not possible.
Please note:
Gigaset.net supports broadband telephony:
Gigaset.net calls that you make from your
Gigaset S685/S675 IP (base station and handset) with a different broadband-capable terminal have excellent sound quality.
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Every Gigaset VoIP device is assigned a
Gigaset.net phone number by default
(page 142).
All registered subscribers are included in
the Gigaset.net directory, which you are
able to access.
You can use an echo service provided by
the telephone number 12341#9 on the
Gigaset.net Web page to test your VoIP
connection
After an announcement, the echo service
sends back the voice data you have sent
immediately in the form of an echo.
Exclusion of liability
Gigaset.net is a voluntary service provided by
Gigaset Communications GmbH with no liability or guarantee for the availability of the network. This service can be terminated at any
time with a notice period of three months.
Please note:
If you do not use your Gigaset.net connection
for six weeks, it is automatically deactivated.
You cannot be reached for calls from the
Gigaset.net.
The connection is re-activated:
– as soon as you start a search in the
Gigaset.net directory or
– make a call via Gigaset.net (dial a number
with #9 at the end) or
– activate the connection via the Web configurator (page 116).
Searching for subscribers in the
Gigaset.net directory
Your handset is in idle status.
Press and hold.
If necessary, select Gigaset.net
from the list of available
online directories and press
§OK§.
Or:
¤ Open the directory with the button.
¤ Select the directory entry Gigaset.net
and press the talk key . A connection to the Gigaset.net directory is
established.
Please note:
– The Gigaset.net directory entry is transferred
to a handset when it is registered with the
base station. Provided the handset can
send and receive directory entries.
– Calls to the Gigaset.net directory are always
free of charge.
– You can also open the Gigaset.net directory
by dialling 1188#9 (phone number of the
Gigaset.net directory) and pressing the talk
key .
If no connection can be made to the
Gigaset.net directory, an error message
34
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / telephony.fm / 27.10.08
VoIP telephony via Gigaset.net
will be sent and the handset will go into
idle status.
Once the connection has been established, you will be asked to enter a name
that you want to search for.
Nickname search:
Enter the name or part of a
name (max. 25 characters).
§Options§
Press the display key.
Start search Select and press §OK§.
If the search has been successful, a hit list
will be displayed of all the names that
begin with the specified character string.
Example:
Search result
3/50
1
Saal, Franz
Sailor, Ben
2
Sand, Anna
Sand, Marie Elisabe...
Sand, Otto
Sang, Joseph
View
Options
1. 3/50: Entry number/number of hits
2. Name of an entry, possibly abbreviated
You can scroll through the hit list with .
Version 4, 16.09.2005
If it has not been possible to find a matching entry, a corresponding message is displayed. You have the following options:
¤ Press the display key §New§ to start a new
search.
Or
¤ Press the display key §Change§ to change
the search criteria. The previously
entered name is copied and can be
edited.
If there are too many matching entries in
the Gigaset.net directory, the message Too
many entries found! is displayed instead of a
hit list.
¤ Press the display key §Refine§ to start a
refined search. The previously entered
name is copied and can be edited/
expanded.
Calling subscribers
Select the subscriber from the
hit list and press the talk key.
Viewing the subscriber's number
Select the subscriber from the
hit list.
§View§
Press the display key.
The display shows the Gigaset.net number
and the subscriber's name, whereby the
name may appear over a number of lines.
Please note:
– Connections to Gigaset.net are always
established via the Internet irrespective of
which default connection is set on your
phone. Pressing and holding or pressing it briefly and a "*" at the end of the
number have no effect.
– You can open the Gigaset.net directory and
establish connections, even if you have not
entered yourself in the Gigaset.net directory.
Using other functions
Precondition: The hit list is displayed.
(select entry) ¢ §Options§
The following functions can be selected
with :
Add to directory
Copy the number to the handset directory. The number and name (where
appropriate abbreviated, max. 16 characters) are copied to the directory.
¤ Edit and save entry where appropriate (page 41).
The hit list is displayed again.
35
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / telephony.fm / 27.10.08
VoIP telephony via Gigaset.net
New search
Start a search with a new name
(page 35).
Own details
See "Entering, editing and deleting
own entry" on page 36.
Please note:
If you select a Gigaset.net number from the
local directory, the connection is automatically
established via the Gigaset.net (Internet).
Entering, editing and deleting
own entry
You have the following options:
u Edit the name of your entry in the
Gigaset.net directory
u Delete your entry from the Gigaset.net
directory
u If you did not enter a name when using
the phone for the first time (page 17),
specify a name and enter yourself in
the directory.
Viewing own entry
You are connected to the Gigaset.net
directory:
¤ Select §Options§ ¢ Own details and press
§OK§.
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Your Gigaset.net number and, where
applicable, your currently entered name
are displayed.
36
Entering/editing a name
Press the display key.
Edit name or enter new name
(max. 25 characters) and press
§OK§.
You can delete the name with
X.
If there is no existing entry with this name
in the Gigaset.net directory, the name is
saved. A message to this effect is displayed. The handset switches to idle status.
If there is an existing entry with this name,
or the entered name contains impermissible characters, you will be requested to
enter a different name.
§Edit§
Please note:
If you delete the name, your entry will be
deleted from the directory. You are no longer
"visible" to other Gigaset.net subscribers. However, you can still be reached via your
Gigaset.net number. For information on how
to display the number, see page 142.
Calling a Gigaset.net subscriber
You can call a Gigaset.net subscriber
directly via the Gigaset.net directory (see
above) or via their Gigaset. net number:
/
Enter the Gigaset.net number
(including the #9) or select
from the handset directory.
Press the talk key.
Every number ending with #9 is dialled via
Gigaset.net.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / netservices_SAG.fm / 27.10.08
Network services
Network services
Activating/deactivating "anonymous
calling" for the next call
Network services are functions made
available by your fixed line network or
VoIP provider.
You can change the setting for withholding caller ID for the next call.
v ¢ Sel. Services ¢ Next Call
Anonymous:
Select Yes / No to activate/
deactivate withholding caller
ID and press §Dial§.
If necessary, enter the phone
number with line suffix.
§Send§
Press the display key. The
phone number is dialled. If
you have not specified a line
suffix, the number will be
dialled via the default connection.
Anonymous calling –
withholding caller ID
Phone number identification can be withheld (CLIR = Calling Line Identification
Restriction). Your number will not be displayed when making outgoing calls. You
are calling anonymously.
Preconditions:
u For anonymous calls via your fixed line
network connection you need to have
requested the relevant service (feature)
from your fixed line network provider.
u Anonymous calls are only possible via
VoIP connections through providers
that support the "anonymous calling"
function. You may have to ask your VoIP
provider to activate this function.
Activating/deactivating anonymous
calling for all calls
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Withholding caller ID can be activated/
deactivated permanently for all your
phone's connections (fixed line network
and VoIP).
When this function is activated, the phone
number will be withheld both for fixed
line network calls and for calls via a VoIP
connection. Withholding caller ID is activated for all registered handsets.
v ¢ Sel. Services
Always anon.
Select and press §OK§ ( ‰ = on).
If the Always anon. function is activated,
Withhold number active is shown in the
handset's idle display.
Further network services in the
fixed line network
The following network services can only
be used for making calls via the fixed line
network. You will need to request them
from your fixed line network provider.
¤ If you require assistance, please contact your network provider.
Settings for all calls
If you have completed one of the following procedures, a code is sent.
¤ After confirmation from the telephone
network, press the end call key .
You can set the following features:
General call forwarding
v ¢ ¢ Fixed Line ¢ Call Divert
¤ Change multiple line input:
When:
Select All Calls / No Answer / When Busy.
All Calls: Calls are forwarded immediately, i.e. no more calls to your fixed
line number are signalled on your
phone.
37
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / netservices_SAG.fm / 27.10.08
Network services
No Answer: Calls are forwarded if noone replies within several rings.
When Busy: Calls are forwarded if your
line is busy.
Call No.:
Press the display key §Edit§. Enter number
to which call is to be forwarded and
press §Save§. You can enter a fixed line,
VoIP or mobile number.
Status:
Activate/deactivate call forwarding.
¤ Press the display key §Send§.
¤ Press the end call key after the
announcement from the telephone
network.
Activating/deactivating call waiting
If call waiting is activated, a caller on the
fixed line network will hear the ringing
tone if you are already conducting a
phone conversation using your fixed line
connection. This call is announced acoustically and visually on your handset
screen.
Calls on the VoIP connection are not
shown as call waiting. They are signalled
on other registered handsets. If no other
handset is available, the caller will hear
the busy tone.
Accepting/rejecting a waiting call, see
page 38.
v ¢ ¢ Fixed Line ¢ Call Waiting
Status:
Activate/deactivate.
¤ Press the display key §Send§.
¤ Press the end call key after the
announcement from the telephone
network.
Please note:
Version 4, 16.09.2005
The setting does not affect the procedure for
call waiting on the VoIP connection. For how to
activate/deactivate call waiting for the VoIP
connection, see page 39.
38
Functions during a call
Initiating ringback
You hear the busy tone.
§Options§ ¢ Ringback
Press the end call key.
Consultation call
During a call:
§Ext.Call§
Press the display key.
Enter a number or copy it from
the directory and press §OK§.
The number will be dialled via the fixed
line connection.
Please note:
After a few seconds, the number selected for a
consultation call is saved in the last number
redial list.
You have the following options:
u Toggling:
¤ Use to toggle between the participants.
– End call with active participant:
§Options§ End Active Call.
– End call with both participants:
press the end call key .
Accepting a waiting call
Precondition: Call waiting is activated
(page 38).
§Accept§
Press the display key.
Or: if the caller's number is not transferred:
§Options§ ¢ Accept waiting call
You have the option of toggling or holding
a conference call.
Please note:
– Without CLIP, a waiting call is only
announced with a signal tone.
– If the first call was an internal call, the internal connection is ended.
– An internal call waiting is shown on the display. You can neither accept the internal
call nor reject it.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / netservices_SAG.fm / 27.10.08
Network services
Functions after a call
Cancelling ringback
v ¢ ¢ Ringback Off
If you have cancelled the ringback, a code
is sent.
¤ After confirmation from the telephone
network, press the end call key .
Further network services for
VoIP
You can use the following network services to make calls via the VoIP connection.
Settings for all calls
General call forwarding
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Precondition: The VoIP provider supports
call forwarding.
v ¢ ¢ VoIP ¢ Call Divert
The display shows a list of configured and
activated VoIP phone numbers and the
Gigaset.net number of your telephone.
Numbers for which call forwarding is activated are marked with ‰ .
¤ Select the phone number for which you
want to activate or deactivate call forwarding, and press §OK§.
¤ Change multiple line input:
When:
Select All Calls / No Answer / When Busy.
All Calls: Calls are forwarded immediately, i.e. no more calls are signalled on
your phone for this VoIP phone
number.
No Answer: Calls are forwarded if noone replies within several rings.
When Busy: Calls are forwarded if your
line is busy.
Call No.:
Press the display key §Edit§. Enter number
to which call is to be forwarded and
press §Save§.
You can state a fixed line network, VoIP
or mobile number for forwarding calls
from a VoIP number.
You must state another Gigaset.net
number for call forwarding from your
Gigaset.net number.
Status:
Activate/deactivate call forwarding.
¤ Press the display key §Save§.
Please note that call forwarding from your
VoIP number may incur additional costs. Please
consult your VoIP provider.
Activating/deactivating call waiting
Precondition: Your phone will permit two
parallel VoIP connections (s. Allow 1 VoIP
call only on page 117).
If call waiting is activated, a caller on one
of your VoIP connections will hear the
ringing tone if you are already on a call
using this VoIP connection. This call is
announced acoustically and visually on
your handset screen.
Calls on the fixed line connection are not
signalled as call waiting. They are signalled on other registered handsets to
which the fixed line number has been allocated as a receive number. If no other
handset is available, the caller will hear
the busy tone.
Accepting/rejecting a waiting call, see
page 40.
v ¢ ¢ VoIP ¢ Call Waiting
Status:
Activate/deactivate.
¤ Press the display key §Save§.
Please note:
The setting applies to all VoIP phone numbers.
It does not affect the procedure for call waiting
on the fixed line connection. For how to activate/deactivate call waiting for the fixed line
connection, see page 38.
39
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / netservices_SAG.fm / 27.10.08
Network services
Functions during a call
Accepting a waiting call
Precondition: Your phone will permit two
parallel VoIP connections (see Allow 1 VoIP
call only on page 117).
Precondition: Call waiting is activated
(page 39).
§Accept§
Press the display key.
You have the option of toggling or holding
a conference call.
Consultation call
During a call:
§Ext.Call§
Press the display key.
Enter the number or copy
from the directory and briefly
press/press and hold the
talk key .
The number must be dialled via VoIP.
.
Please note:
After a few seconds, the number selected for a
consultation call is saved in the last number
redial list.
Version 4, 16.09.2005
If the participant answers, you have the
following options:
u Toggling:
¤ Use to toggle between the participants.
¤ End call with active participant:
§Options§ End Active Call.
u Conference call:
¤ Call both participants: press the display key §Conf.§.
¤ End the conference call (toggling):
press display key §EndConf§.
¤ End call with both participants:
press the end call key .
u Forwarding (provider dependent):
Precondition: You are toggling calls
and you phoned the currently active
participant yourself.
¤ To connect the two external participants:
§Options§ Call Transfer
If call forwarding was successful, a
message will appear to this effect. The
handset will then switch to idle.
40
Please note:
– If the first call was an internal call, the internal connection is ended.
– An internal call waiting is shown on the display. You can neither accept the internal
call nor reject it.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / directories_charges.fm / 27.10.08
Using the directory and lists
Using the directory and lists
The options are:
u Directory
u Call-by-call list
u If applicable, online directories
u Last number redial list
u E-mail, SMS and messenger list
u Calls list
u Answer machine list
You can store a maximum of 250 entries in
the directory and call-by-call list (the
actual number depends on the size of the
individual entries).
You create the directory and call-by-call
list for your own individual handset. However, you can send the lists or individual
entries to other handsets (page 43).
Directory/call-by-call list
Please note:
For quick access to a number from the directory or the call-by-call list (quick dial), you can
assign the number to a key (page 43).
Directory
In the directory, you can save
u Up to three numbers and associated
first names and surnames
u VIP designation and VIP ringer tone
(optional)
u E-mail address (optional)
u CLIP pictures (optional)
u Anniversaries with reminder
¤ With the handset in idle status, open
Version 4, 16.09.2005
the directory by pressing the key.
Length of the entries (directory)
3 numbers:
each max. 32 digits
First name and surname:
each max. 16 characters
E-mail address
max. 60 characters
Please note:
Some VoIP providers do not support local calls
for calls to the fixed line network. In this case,
always enter the fixed line number with the
area code in your directory. Alternatively, you
can also use the Web configurator to define an
area code, which is automatically prefixed to
all numbers that are dialled via VoIP without an
area code (page 123).
Call-by-call list
The call-by-call list is used to store access
codes for network providers (called "callby-call numbers"), that can be put ahead
of the numbers when dialling via the fixed
line network.
¤ Open the call-by-call list in idle status
by pressing the C key.
Length of entries
Number:
Name:
max. 32 digits
max. 16 characters
Storing a number in the directory
¢ New Entry
¤ Change multiple line input:
First Name / Surname:
Enter a name in at least one of the
fields.
Phone (Home) / Phone (Office) / Phone (Mobile)
Enter a number in at least one of the
fields.
E-mail
Enter e-mail address.
41
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / directories_charges.fm / 27.10.08
Using the directory and lists
Annivers.:
Select On or Off.
With setting On:
Enter Anniversary (Date) and Annivers.
(Time) (page 45) and select reminder
type: Annivers. (Signal).
Caller Picture
Precondition: Calling Line Identification
(CLIP).
If required, select a picture to be displayed when the caller calls.
The options are:
– CLIP pictures that are supplied with
the handset.
– Additionally for the Gigaset S68H,
your own pictures that have been
loaded onto the handset from your
PC (page 149).
The pictures are saved in the My Stuff
section of the handset (page 90).
¤ Save changes (page 147).
Please note:
– To find out how to enter IP addresses, turn
to page 27.
– If you want to dial a certain number using
the same line connection each time, you
can add the relevant line suffix to the
number in question (page 27).
– If you add a star (*) at the end of the
number, the number will be dialled via the
non-standard connection (page 98), even
if you briefly press the talk key . On condition that no dialling plan has been
defined for the number (page 124).
– You can use the Web configurator to save
the directory to a file on your PC, where it
can be edited and then sent back to the
handset (page 130). Or you can transfer
Outlook contacts from the PC to the handset's directory.
Storing a number in the call-by-call list
C ¢ New Entry
¤ Change multiple line input:
Number:
Enter the number.
Name:
Enter name.
Selecting entries in the directory and
call-by-call list
/C
Open the directory or call-bycall list.
You have the following options:
u Use to scroll to the entry until the
required name is selected.
u Enter the first character of the name (in
the directory: first character of the surname or of the first name if only the
first name has been entered), or scroll
to the entry using .
Dialling with the directory/call-by-call
list
/ C ¢ (Select entry; page 42)
Briefly press/press and hold
the talk key. The number is
dialled using the selected connection type (page 26).
Please note:
You can only dial IP addresses via VoIP.
Managing directory/call-by-call list
entries
/C
¢ (Select entry; page 42)
Viewing entries
§View§
Press the display key. The
entry is displayed.
Back with §OK§.
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Editing entries
Press the display keys one after
the other.
Carry out changes and save.
§View§ §Edit§
¤
42
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / directories_charges.fm / 27.10.08
Using the directory and lists
Using other functions
/C
¢ (Select entry; page 42)
Open menu.
The following functions can be selected
with :
§Options§
Display Number
Change or add to a saved number and
then dial it (press talk key ).
Edit Entry
Edit selected entry.
Delete Entry
Delete selected entry.
VIP Entry (directory only)
Mark a directory entry as VIP (Very
Important Person) and assign it a particular ringer tone. You can then identify VIP calls by their ringer tone melody.
Precondition: Calling Line Identification (page 29).
Copy Entry
Send a single entry to a handset
(page 43).
Delete List
Delete all entries in the directory or in
the call-by-call list.
Copy List
Send complete list to a handset
(page 43).
Available Memory
Display the available entries in the
directory and call-by-call list.
A number with a star (*) at the end will be
dialled via the non-default connection.
If no suffix is entered, the number will be
dialled via the default connection. Exception: A dialling plan has been defined for
the number (page 124).
Sending the directory/call-by-call list
to another handset
Preconditions:
u The sending and receiving handsets
must both be registered to the same
base station.
u The other handset can send and receive
directory entries.
/ C ¢ (Select entry; page 42)
¢ §Options§ ¢ Copy Entry / Copy List
¢ to Internal
Select the internal number of
the receiving handset and
press §OK§.
A successful transfer is confirmed by a
message and confirmation tone on the
receiving handset.
You can transfer several individual entries
one after the other by responding §Yes§ to
the Copy next entry? prompt.
Please note:
You can also send the complete directory via
data transfer, without opening the directory:
Data Transfer
Directory
v
£
£
£
Please note:
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Using quick dial keys
How to assign numbers to the digit keys
on your handset is described on page 87.
¤ Press and hold the required quick dial
key.
If there is a valid line suffix at the end of
the number in the directory (e.g.: #1), the
number will be dialled via the line belonging to the suffix (page 111).
A number with a hash key (#) only at the
end will be dialled via the default connection.
u Entries with identical numbers are not
overwritten in the receiver handset.
u The transfer is cancelled if the phone
rings or if the memory of the receiving
handset is full.
43
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / directories_charges.fm / 27.10.08
Using the directory and lists
Gigaset S68H: transferring the
directory entries as a vCard with
Bluetooth
In Bluetooth mode (see page 94), you can
transfer directory entries in vCard format,
e.g. to exchange entries with your mobile.
Preconditions:
u Your own area code is stored in the
phone (page 95)
u Bluetooth is activated (page 94)
u The device that you want to send the
entries to (e.g. mobile), is registered
with the handset as a Bluetooth device
(page 94)
¢ (Select entry) ¢ §Options§
¢ Copy Entry / Copy List
vCard via Bluetooth
Select and press §OK§.
The Known Devices list is displayed
(page 94).
Select device and press §OK§.
Receiving a vCard with Bluetooth
Version 4, 16.09.2005
If a device from the Known Devices
(page 94) list sends a vCard to your handset, this occurs automatically and you are
informed about it via the display.
If the sending device does not appear in
the list, you will be asked on the display to
enter the device PIN for the sending
device:
If necessary, enter the PIN for
the sending Bluetooth device
and press §OK§.
The transferred vCard is available as a
directory entry.
44
Copying a displayed number to the
directory
You can copy numbers to the directory
that are displayed in a list, e.g. the calls list
or the last number redial list, in an SMS or
during a call.
A number is displayed:
§Options§ ¢ Copy to Directory
Or:
Press the display key.
The directory is opened.
New Entry / Directory entry
Select and press §OK§.
!/"/#
Select and press §OK§.
The number is copied to the relevant
number field (Phone (Home) / Phone (Office)
/ Phone (Mobile)).
¤ Complete the entry if necessary, see
page 41.
During the number transfer from the
answer machine list, the message playback is interrupted.
Copying a number or e-mail address
from the directory
In many operating situations, you can
open the directory to copy a number or email address, for example. Your handset
need not be in idle status.
¤ Depending on the operating situation,
open the directory with or %.
Select an entry (page 42).
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / directories_charges.fm / 27.10.08
Using the directory and lists
Saving an anniversary in the directory
Viewing missed anniversaries
You can save an anniversary for every
number in the directory and specify a time
when you will receive a reminder call on
the anniversary.
Anniversaries are automatically recorded
in the calendar (page 92).
¢ (Select entry; page 42)
§View§ §Edit§ Press the display keys one after
the other.
Scroll to the Annivers.: line.
v
Select On.
¤ Change multiple line input:
Anniversary (Date)
Enter day/month/year in 8-digit format.
Annivers. (Time)
Enter the hour/minute for the reminder
call in 4-digit format.
Annivers. (Signal)
Select the type of signal for the
reminder.
¤ Save changes (page 147).
In idle status, you are reminded of an
elapsed and unacknowledged anniversary
by the one-off display of §Appoint.§.
¤ View appointment:
§Appoint.§
Press the display key.
You now have the following options:
Please note:
A time must be specified for reminder calls. If
you select a visual signal, a time is not required
and is automatically set to 00.00.
Deactivating anniversaries
¢ (Select entry; page 42)
§View§ §Edit§
v
§Save§
Press the display keys one after
the other.
Scroll to the Annivers.: line.
Select Off.
Press the display key.
Reminder call on an anniversary
Version 4, 16.09.2005
A reminder call is signalled on the handset
using the selected ringer tone.
You have the following options:
§SMS§
Write an SMS.
§Off§
Write an SMS.
§Delete§
Delete reminder.
After deleting, press the display key or §Go Back§:
Back in idle status, §Appoint.§ is
no longer displayed.
You can also view missed anniversaries
afterwards (see page 93).
§SMS§
Using online directories
You can use online directories (= online
directories and classified directories,
e.g. "Yellow Pages") depending on your
provider.
You can define which online directories
you wish to use via the Web configurator
(page 129).
Exclusion of liability
Gigaset Communications GmbH assumes no
guarantee or liability for the availability of this
service. The service may be discontinued at
any time.
Opening an online/classified directory
Precondition: The handset is idle and a
VoIP connection is available.
Press and hold. This opens the
list of online directories. Provider-specific names appear in
the display.
Select directory (online directory or classified directory)
from the list and press §OK§.
Press the display key to
acknowledge and end the
reminder call.
45
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / directories_charges.fm / 27.10.08
Using the directory and lists
Or:
You can find the Net Directory, Yellow Pages
entries for online directories in the local
directories of the registered handsets. You
can use these entries to access the online
directories assigned to your handset
(page 129).
¤ Open the directory with the button.
¤ Select the Net Directory entry for the
online directory or the Yellow Pages
entry for the classified directory and
press the talk key .
This establishes a connection to the online
directory or the classified directory.
Please note:
– The directory entries Net Directory / Yellow
Pages are transferred to the handset when
it is registered with the base station
(page 81). Precondition: The handset can
receive directory entries.
– You can also establish a connection to the
online directory as follows:
When the handset is idle, dial 1#91 and
then press the talk key .
To establish a connection to the classified directory, dial 2#91.
To establish a connection to the
Gigaset.net directory, dial 1188#9.
Calls to the online directory are always free of
charge.
Version 4, 16.09.2005
¥
¥
¥
46
Searching for an entry
Precondition: You have opened the
online telephone/classified directory.
¤ Making a multi-line entry:
Surname: (Online directory) /
Category/Name: (Classified directory)
Enter the name, part of a
name or the trade sector (max.
30 characters).
City:
Enter the name of the town in
which the subscriber you are
searching for lives.
Number:
Enter the number (max.
30 characters).
¤ Press the display key §Search§ to start the
search.
You must make an entry in either Surname:
or Category/Name: and in City: or in
Number. Searching by number is only possible if supported by the online directory
you have selected. Entering text see
page 147.
A list of found towns will be displayed if
the search returns more than one result:
Select the town.
Use §View§ to display detailed
information on the selected
town.
If no matching town is found:
Press §Edit§ if you want to
change the search criteria.
The entries for Category/Name
and City are adopted and can
be changed.
§OK§
Press the display key to continue the search.
A corresponding message will appear on
the display if no subscriber is found to
match the search criteria. You have the following options:
¤ Press the display key §New§ to start a new
search.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / directories_charges.fm / 27.10.08
Using the directory and lists
Or
¤ Press the display key §Edit§ to change the
search criteria. The stated name and
town are adopted and can be changed.
No hits will be displayed if the list of hits is
too large. A message to this effect is displayed.
¤ Press the display key §Refine§ to start a
refined search (page 47).
Or
¤ Provider-dependent: You can view the
list if the number of hits is shown on
the display. Press the display key §View§.
Search result (hit list)
The search result is shown as a list on the
display. Example:
Net Directory
2/50
Sand, Marie Elisabe...
0049123456789
Parkstraße 11
Berlin, Germany
1
2
You have the following additional options
via §Options§:
Refine search
Refine search criteria and
restrict list (page 47).
New search Start a new search.
Copy to Directory
Transfer the entry number to
the handset's directory
(page 44). The surname is
transferred to the name field
of the directory.
Calling subscribers
Precondition: A hit list is displayed.
¤ Select the entry and press the talk key
.
This dials the number in the display if
there is only one number.
A list of numbers appears if there is more
than one number.
¤ Select the number with and press
the talk key once again.
Start detailed search
View
Options
1. 2/50: Consecutive number/total number of
hits (only the consecutive number is displayed if the total number of hits >99)
2. Four lines with subscriber's name, trade
sector, telephone number and address
(possibly abridged)
Version 4, 16.09.2005
You have the following options:
¤ You can scroll through the hit list with
.
¤ Press the display key §View§. Displays the
unabridged details of the entry (name,
trade sector where applicable, address,
telephone numbers). You can scroll
through the entry with .
You can use the search options available in
the detailed search (first name and/or
street) to limit the number of hits returned
by a previous search.
Precondition: A search result is displayed
(hit list with multiple entries or a message
indicating too many hits).
§Refine§
Press the display key.
Or
§Options§ ¢ Refine search
Select and press §OK§.
The search criteria from the previous
search are adopted and entered in the corresponding fields.
Surname: (Online directory) /
Category/Name: (Classified directory)
If necessary, change name/
trade sector or extend partial
name.
47
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / directories_charges.fm / 27.10.08
Using the directory and lists
If necessary, change the name
of the town.
Street:
If necessary, change the name
of the street (max. 30 chars.).
First name: (only in the online directory)
If necessary, enter the first
name (max. 30 characters).
§Search§
Start detailed search.
City:
Last number redial list
The last number redial list contains the
20 numbers last dialled with the handset
(max. 32 digits). If one of the numbers is
in the directory, the corresponding name
will be displayed.
Dialling from the last number redial list
Press the key briefly.
Select an entry.
Briefly press/press and hold
the talk key. The number is
dialled using the selected connection type (page 26).
When a name is displayed, you can display
the corresponding phone number by
pressing the §View§ display key.
Managing entries in the last number
redial list
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Press the key briefly.
Select an entry.
§Options§
Open menu.
The following functions can be selected
with :
Copy to Directory
Copying a displayed number to the
directory (page 44).
Automatic Redial
The selected number is automatically
dialled at fixed intervals (at least every
20 seconds). The handsfree key flashes
and "open listening" is activated.
48
– Party answers: press the talk key
. The function is ended.
– Party does not answer: the call is terminated after approx. 30 seconds.
The function is ended after pressing
any key or after ten unsuccessful
attempts.
Display Number
(As in the directory, page 43)
Delete Entry
Delete selected entry.
Delete List
Delete complete list.
Opening lists with the
message key
You can use the message key to open
the following lists:
u Answer machine list
u Network mailbox, see page 78
A separate list is displayed for each network mailbox.
Precondition: Its number is saved in
the base station, it is switched on
(page 78, page 126) and the corresponding VoIP/fixed line network
number is assigned to the handset as a
receive number.
u SMS list, see page 55
If several mailboxes are set up
(page 57), several lists will be displayed, if required.
u Incoming e-mail list, see page 68
The list is only shown if new messages
have arrived in the mailbox from the
incoming e-mail server.
u Calls list
u Messenger message list, see page 75
The list is only shown on the handset
that is online.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / directories_charges.fm / 27.10.08
Using the directory and lists
An advisory tone sounds as soon as a new
message arrives in a list. The key
flashes (it stops when the key is pressed).
In idle status, the display shows an icon for
the new message:
Icon
New message...
... in one of your network mailboxes or
... in the answer machine list
&
... in calls list
'
... in the SMS, messenger or email list
The number of new entries is shown
beneath the corresponding icon.
List selection
Pressing the button will only display
lists that contain messages and also the
network mailbox lists Net AM: ....
Lists with new messages are shown first
and identified in bold. The number of
messages received are shown in brackets.
If a list contains no new messages, the
number of old messages will be shown.
Exception: (0) is displayed for Net AM: ...
network mailboxes.
Example:
Messages & Calls
Precondition: Calling Line Identification
(CLIP, page 29).
Depending on the type of list set, the calls
list contains
u Received calls (marked with ‰ )
u Missed calls
The numbers of the last 30 calls are saved.
Multiple calls from the same number will
be stored once in the list of missed calls
(the latest call). The number of calls from
this number is shown in brackets after the
entry.
Multiple calls from the same number are
stored several times in the list of answered
calls.
The list of missed calls does not contain
calls that were answered and calls that
were recorded by the answer machine.
Please note:
– Only calls to the receive numbers assigned
to your handset are stored in the calls list
(page 120).
If no receive numbers are assigned, all calls
will be stored in the calls list for all handsets.
– You can also call up the call history via the
menu: v
£
Net AM: IP1
(1)
Setting the calls list type
Ans M.:
Calls List:
Net AM: Fxd. line
Net AM: IP2
(2)
(4)
(0)
(0)
OK
v ¢ ¢ Base ¢ Calls List Type
Missed Calls / All Calls
Select and press §OK§ ( ‰ = on).
Press and hold (idle status).
The calls list entries are retained when you
change the list type.
¤ Select a list with and press §OK§.
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Calls list
49
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / directories_charges.fm / 27.10.08
Using the directory and lists
List entry in calls list
New messages are displayed at the top.
Example of list entries:
All Calls
Susi Sorglos
15.01.08
‰
12:20
Louise Miller
14.01.08
Selecting from the calls list
¢ Calls List: (2)
Select entry.
Briefly press/press and hold
the talk key. The number is
dialled using the selected connection type (page 26).
11:15
Answer machine list
(Gigaset S675/S685 IP)
Delete
Options
u List type in header: Missed Calls,
All Calls
u Status of entry
Bold: New entry
u Number or name of caller
You can add the caller's number to the
directory (page 44).
u Date and time of call (if set, page 11)
Managing entries in the calls list
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Pressing the display key §Delete§ deletes the
marked entry.
After pressing the display key §Options§ you
can select more functions with :
Copy to Directory
Copying a displayed number to the
directory.
Information
If a URI was received and stored for a
VoIP call, this will be shown. The URI is
dialled if you press the talk key .
The URI is not entered on the last
number redial list.
Delete List
Delete complete list.
After exiting the calls list, all entries are set
to "old" status and are no longer shown in
bold.
50
The answer machine list Ans M.: is only displayed on handsets that have at least one
receive number in common with the
answer machine.
You can use the answer machine list to listen to the messages stored on the base
station answer machine.
The first new message received is displayed at the top of the answer machine
list. Playback starts when the list is
opened.
New messages are placed after old messages when they have been played back.
All messages are played back irrespective
of the associated receive number.
Old messages are played back if the list
does not contain any new messages.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / directories_charges.fm / 27.10.08
Making cost-effective calls
List entry in the answer machine list
Example of list entries:
Message Playback
Susi Sorglos
15.01.08
Louise Miller
14.01.08
Delete
12:20
11:15
Options
u Status of entry
Bold: New entry
u Number or name of caller
You can add the caller's number to the
directory (page 44).
u Call date and time (if set, page 11).
How to manage messages in the answer
machine list is described on page 63.
Dialling numbers from the answer
machine list
Version 4, 16.09.2005
¢ Ans M.: (2)
Select entry.
Briefly press/press and hold
the talk key. The number is
dialled using the selected connection type (page 26).
Making cost-effective calls
Using the Internet (VoIP) is the preferred
cost-effective way of making calls.
You can also use your phone's cost control
function for calls to fixed line or mobile
phone networks. Open accounts with various VoIP providers who offer favourable
rates for calls to other networks. In the
phone configuration, define the best VoIP
connections (account), e.g. for specific
regional, national and mobile network
prefixes, to be used when calls are made
(Dialling Plans, page 124). Or define the
VoIP connection to be used when dialling
the number (dialling with line suffix,
page 27).
If you are using your fixed line network
phone, choose a network provider who
offers particularly favourable rates (callby-call). You can manage call-by-call numbers in the call-by-call list.
Linking call-by-call numbers with
one number
You can prefix a network provider's
number ("chaining") to numbers dialled
via a fixed line network.
C
Open call-by-call list.
Select entry (call-by-call
number).
§Options§
Press the display key.
Display Number
Select and press §OK§.
/ Enter number or dial number
from the directory (page 44).
Briefly press/press and hold
the talk key so that the
number is dialled via the fixed
line network. Both numbers
are dialled.
51
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / directories_charges.fm / 27.10.08
Making cost-effective calls
Please note:
You can also dial "chained" numbers via a fixed
line network by adding the line suffix #0 (for
the fixed line network) to the end of the
number. Alternatively, you can define appropriate rules for call-by-call numbers
(page 124).
Displaying the call duration
The duration of each call appears in the
display for calls made via a fixed line network and VoIP
u during the conversation,
u until about three seconds after the call
has ended if you do not replace the
handset in the charging cradle.
Please note:
Version 4, 16.09.2005
The actual duration of the call can vary from
that shown by a few seconds.
52
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / sms_BRD_neutral.fm / 27.10.08
SMS (text messages)
SMS (text messages)
You can only send and receive SMS messages via the fixed line network.
When an SMS is sent, the base station
automatically establishes a connection via
the fixed line network.
Your phone is supplied ready for sending
SMS messages immediately.
Preconditions:
u Calling Line Identification is enabled for
your fixed line network connection.
u Your network provider supports SMS in
Version 4, 16.09.2005
the fixed line network (information on
this can be obtained from your network
provider).
u You are registered with your service
provider to send and receive SMS.
SMS messages are exchanged between
SMS centres operated by service providers. You must enter the SMS centre
through which you wish to send and
receive SMS messages into your phone.
You can receive SMS messages from every
SMS centre that is entered, provided you
have registered with your service provider.
Your SMS messages are sent via the Service Centr. that is entered as the active
send service centre. However, you can
activate any other SMS centre as the active
send service centre to send a current message (page 58).
If no SMS service centre is entered,
the SMS menu only contains the entry
Settings . Enter an SMS service centre
(page 58).
Information on writing an SMS can be
found in the appendix:
u For how to enter text, see page 147.
u Writing using the predictive text tool
EATONI, see page 148.
Rules
u For more than 160 characters, the SMS
will be sent as a linked SMS (up to four
SMS messages each containing 152 or
153 characters, depending on the
length of the linking information).
The following will be shown on the top
right in the header when an SMS is
being written (example):
1
SMS
596(1)
2
1 Maximum number of characters you can
still write or attach.
2 Number of SMS messages that need to
be linked for the text written so far.
Please note that linking SMS messages usually
incurs higher charges.
Please note:
u If your phone is connected to a PABX,
see page 59.
u To receive SMS messages you must be
registered with your service provider.
Registering with the registration
assistant
The first time you open the v ¢ ¢ SMS menu, you will be asked whether
you wish to be registered automatically
with all entered SMS centres (see
page 58). Confirm with §Yes§. You can now
receive SMS messages from all SMS centres whose numbers you have entered.
If you answer with §No§, automatic registration will be cancelled. You can start automatic registration at a later time via the
menu:
Precondition: SMS centres have been
entered.
v ¢ ¢ SMS ¢ Settings
¢ Subscribe to SMS
The registration assistant does not support setting up personal mailboxes
(page 57).
53
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / sms_BRD_neutral.fm / 27.10.08
SMS (text messages)
Writing/sending an SMS
Writing an SMS
v ¢ ¢ SMS
Mailbox 2 Select mailbox if necessary
and press §OK§ (page 57).
Enter mailbox PIN if necessary
and press §OK§.
New SMS Select and press §OK§.
Write an SMS.
Please note:
– Entering text with and without EATONI predictive text is described from page 148.
– EATONI is activated as a default setting.
How to activate/deactivate EATONI,
see page 149.
Sending an SMS
or:
Press the talk key
§Options§
Press the display key.
Select and press §OK§.
Send
Then:
SMS
Select and press §OK§.
/C/
Select number with area code
(even if you are in that area)
from the directory or call-bycall list, or enter number
directly. For sending SMS to an
SMS mailbox: add the mailbox
ID to the end of the number.
§Send§
Press the display key.
The SMS will be sent as soon as your
phone's fixed line network connection is
free.
Please note:
– If you are interrupted by an external call
while writing an SMS, the text is automatically saved in the draft message list.
– If the memory is full, or if the SMS function
on the base station is being used by
another handset, the operation is cancelled. An appropriate message appears in
the display. Delete SMS messages you no
longer require or send the SMS later.
Using other functions
Precondition: You are writing an SMS.
§Options§
Open menu.
The following functions can be selected
with :
Send
Send an SMS.
Save
Save an SMS in the draft message list
(page 54).
Insert E-mail Adr.
Add an e-mail address to the message
text.
Predictive Text
Activate/deactivate predictive text
EATONI, page 148.
Select Language
For EATONI: select the language in
which you wish to write the text and
press §OK§.
Draft message list
You can save an SMS in the draft message
list and edit and send it later.
Saving an SMS in the draft message list
¤ Write an SMS (page 54).
§Options§
Save
Press the display key.
Select and press §OK§.
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Please note:
After saving, the SMS editor will be displayed
again with your SMS. You can continue writing
the text and save it again. The SMS that was
saved previously will be overwritten.
54
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / sms_BRD_neutral.fm / 27.10.08
SMS (text messages)
Opening the draft message list
v ¢ ¢ SMS ¢ (Mailbox, mailbox
PIN)
Outgoing (3)
Select and press §OK§. The
number of SMS messages in
the list will be shown in brackets (e.g. (3)).
The first list entry is displayed, e.g.
1234567890
15.01.08
09:45
Reading or deleting SMS messages
¤ Open the draft message list and then:
Select SMS.
§Read§
Press the display key. The
entry will be displayed. Scroll
line by line using .
Or:
§Options§
Open menu.
Delete Entry Press §OK§. The selected SMS
message is deleted.
You can use §Options§ ¢ Delete all to delete
every SMS in the draft message list.
Writing/changing an SMS
¤ You are reading an SMS in the draft
Version 4, 16.09.2005
message list.
§Options§
Open menu.
You have the following options:
New SMS
Write a new SMS and then send
(page 54) or save it.
Edit
Edit the text of the saved SMS and then
send it (page 54).
Character Set
Text is shown in the selected character
set.
Receiving an SMS
All received SMS messages are saved in
the incoming message list. Linked SMS
messages are displayed as one message. If
this is too long (it consists of too many
linked individual SMS messages) or if it
was not fully transmitted, it will be split
into several individual SMS messages.
Since an SMS remains in the list even after
it has been read, you should regularly
delete SMS messages from the list.
The display tells you if the SMS memory is
full.
¤ Delete SMS messages you no longer
require (page 56).
Incoming message list
The incoming message list contains:
u All received SMS messages, starting
with the most recent.
u SMS messages that could not be sent
due to an error.
New SMS messages are signalled on all
Gigaset S67H/S68H handsets by the '
icon in the display, the flashing message
key and an advisory tone.
Opening the incoming message list with
the key
Press.
Select a mailbox if necessary and enter the
mailbox PIN.
The incoming message list is displayed as
follows (example):
SMS:
(2)
1
2
1 Bold: number of new entries
Regular: number of read entries
2 Name of mailbox, here: general mailbox
Open list with §OK§.
55
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / sms_BRD_neutral.fm / 27.10.08
SMS (text messages)
An entry in the list is displayed as in the
following example:
1234567890
15.01.08 09:45
1
2
1 Number of the sender or name of the
directory entry
2 SMS status:
Bold: new unread SMS messages
Regular: old read SMS messages
Opening the incoming message list via the
SMS menu
v ¢ ¢ SMS ¢ (Mailbox, mailbox
PIN) ¢ Incoming (2)
Reading or deleting individual SMS
messages
¤ Open the incoming message list.
¤ Continue as described in "Reading or
deleting SMS messages", page 55.
After you have read a new SMS, it is given
the status "Old" (it is no longer shown in
bold).
Changing the character set
¤ Read the SMS (page 56):
If you cannot see any text or symbols, the
SMS may have been written with a different character set.
§Options§
Press the display key.
Character Set
Select and press §OK§.
Select character set and press
§OK§.
Text is shown in the selected character set.
Deleting the incoming message list
Version 4, 16.09.2005
All new and old SMS messages in the list
are deleted.
¤ Open the incoming message list.
§Options§
Open menu.
Delete all Select, press §OK§ and confirm
with §Yes§. The list is cleared.
56
Replying to or forwarding SMS
messages
¤ Read the SMS (page 56):
§Options§
Press the display key.
You have the following options:
Reply
Write and send a reply SMS directly
(page 54).
Edit
Edit the text in the SMS and then send
it (page 54).
Forwarding an SMS
¤ You are reading an SMS (page 56):
§Options§
Forward
Press the display key.
Select and press §OK§. For further information, see page 54.
Adding a number to the directory
Copying the sender's number
¤ Open the incoming message list and
select SMS (page 55).
Press the display key. For further information, see page 44.
§Options§
Please note:
– You can create a special directory for SMS
messages within your main directory by
putting a star (*) before the names.
– An attached mailbox identifier is added to
the directory. It must be deleted for 'normal
calls'.
Dialling numbers from SMS texts/
transferring to the directory
¤ Read the SMS (page 56) and scroll to
the telephone number.
The digits are reverse-highlighted.
Briefly press/press and hold
the talk key to dial the number.
Or:
Press the display key to transfer the number to the directory. For further information,
see page 44.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / sms_BRD_neutral.fm / 27.10.08
SMS (text messages)
Please note:
– The + symbol is not transferred for international area codes.
You should then enter '00' at the start of
the number.
– If an SMS contains several numbers, the
next number will be highlighted if you
scroll down until the first number disappears from the display.
¥
If you wish to use the number to send an
SMS:
¤ Save the number with the local area
code (dialling code) in the directory.
Notification by SMS
You can be notified via SMS about missed
calls and also about new answer machine
messages.
Precondition: For missed calls, the caller's
number (CLI) must have been transmitted.
Notification is sent to your mobile phone
or another phone with SMS functionality.
You only need to save the phone number
to which notification should be sent (notification number) and set the notification
type.
Please note that your network provider will
usually charge for SMS notifications.
Saving the notification number
v ¢ ¢ SMS ¢ Settings
¢ Notify Number
Enter the number (including
area code) to which the SMS is
to be sent.
§Save§
Press the display key.
Press and hold (idle status).
Setting the notification type
v ¢ ¢ SMS
¢ Notify Type
¢ Settings
¤ Change multiple line input if necessary:
Missed Calls:
Select On if you require SMS notification.
Ans Machine:
Select On if you require SMS notification.
¤ Save changes (page 147).
SMS mailboxes
The general mailbox is the default setting. Anyone can access this mailbox and
it cannot be protected by a PIN. You can
additionally set up three personal mailboxes and protect these with a PIN. Each
mailbox is identified by a name and a
"mailbox ID" (a kind of extension number).
Please note:
u If you operate a number of devices
(base stations) with SMS functionality
on a single phone line, then each SMS
mailbox ID may only occur once. In this
case you must also change the preset
ID of the general mailbox ("0").
u You can only use personal mailboxes if
your service provider supports this
function. You can tell whether this is
the case by the addition of a star (*) to
the number of a (preset) SMS centre.
u If you have forgotten your mailbox PIN,
you can reset it by restoring the base
station's default settings. This will
delete all SMS messages from all
mailboxes.
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Warning:
Do not enter your own fixed line number for
the notification of missed calls. This can lead to
chargeable endless looping.
57
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / sms_BRD_neutral.fm / 27.10.08
SMS (text messages)
Setting up and changing a personal
mailbox
Setting up a personal mailbox
v ¢ ¢ SMS ¢ Settings
¢ SMS Mailboxes
Select mailbox, e.g. Mailbox 2,
and press §OK§.
¤ Change multiple line input:
On/Off:
Activate or deactivate mailbox.
ID:
Select mailbox ID (0–9). You can only
select the available numbers.
Protection:
Activate/deactivate PIN protection.
PIN
If necessary, enter 4-digit PIN.
¤ Save changes (page 147).
Active mailboxes are marked with ‰ in
the mailbox list. They are shown in the
SMS list and can, if necessary, be displayed
by pressing the message key .
Deactivating a mailbox
¤ Set On/Off: to Off. Confirm
message with §Yes§ if necessary.
All SMS messages saved in this mailbox
will be deleted.
Deactivating PIN protection
¤ Set Protection: to Off.
The mailbox PIN is reset to "0000".
Changing the name of a mailbox
Version 4, 16.09.2005
v ¢ ¢ SMS ¢ Settings ¢ SMS
Mailboxes ¢ (Select mailbox)
§Edit§
Press the display key.
Enter new name.
§Save§
Press the display key.
Press and hold (idle status).
58
Changing a mailbox's PIN and ID
v ¢ ¢ SMS ¢ Settings ¢ SMS
Mailboxes ¢ (Select mailbox)
Enter mailbox PIN if required
and press §OK§.
¤ Set ID:, Protection: and PIN (page 58).
Sending an SMS to a personal mailbox
To send an SMS to a personal mailbox, the
sender must know your ID and enter it
after your number.
¤ You can send your SMS contact an SMS
via your personal mailbox.
Your SMS contact will then receive your
SMS number with current ID and can save
it in their directory. If the ID is invalid, the
SMS will not be delivered.
Setting SMS centres
Entering/changing SMS centres
¤ You should find out about the services
and special functions offered by your
service provider before you make a
new application and/or before you
delete pre-configured call numbers.
v ¢ ¢ SMS ¢ Settings
¢ Service Centres
Select SMS centre (e.g. Service
Centr. 1) and press §OK§.
¤ Change multiple line input:
Active Send:
Select Yes if SMS messages are to be
sent via the SMS centre. For the SMS
centres 2 to 4, the setting only applies
to the next SMS.
SMS:
Press the display key §Edit§. Enter the
number of the SMS service and insert a
star if your service provider supports
personal mailboxes.
¤ Save changes (page 147).
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / sms_BRD_neutral.fm / 27.10.08
SMS (text messages)
Please note:
Ask your service provider for details on how to
enter service numbers if you wish to use personal mailboxes (precondition: your service
provider supports this function).
Sending an SMS through another SMS
centre
¤ Activate the SMS centre (2 to 4) as the
active send service centre.
¤ Send the SMS.
This setting only applies to the next SMS
to be sent. Thereafter, the setting returns
to Service Centr. 1.
SMS on a PABX
u You can only receive an SMS when the
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Calling Line Identification is forwarded to the extension of the PABX
(CLIP). The CLIP evaluation of the
phone number for the SMS centre takes
place in your Gigaset.
u If required, you must prefix the number
for the SMS centre with the access code
(depending on your PABX).
If in doubt, test your PABX, e.g. by
sending an SMS to your own number:
once with and once without the access
code.
u When you send SMS messages, your
sender number may be sent without
your extension number. In this case the
recipient cannot reply to you directly.
Sending and receiving SMS messages on
ISDN PABXs is only possible via the MSN
number assigned to your base station.
Activating/deactivating SMS
function
If you deactivate the SMS function, you
cannot send or receive any SMS messages
with your phone.
The settings you have made for sending
and receiving SMS messages (e.g. the call
numbers of the SMS centres) and the
entries in the incoming and draft message
lists are saved even after you turn off your
phone.
v
Open menu.
NOL
Enter the digits.
Deactivate SMS function.
Q §OK§
Or:
§OK§
Activate SMS function (default
setting).
59
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / sms_BRD_neutral.fm / 27.10.08
SMS (text messages)
SMS troubleshooting
The message is played back.
Error codes when sending
1. The "display call number" service is not activated.
Ask your service provider to activate this
function (chargeable).
E0 Calling Line Identification permanently
withheld (CLIR) or Calling Line Identification not activated.
FE Error occurred during SMS transfer.
FD Connection to SMS centre failed; see selfhelp.
Self-help with errors
The following table lists error situations
and possible causes and provides notes on
troubleshooting.
You cannot send messages.
1. You have not requested the CLIP service
(Calling Line Identification Presentation).
Ask your service provider to enable this
service.
¥
2. SMS transmission has been interrupted
(e.g. by a call).
Re-send the SMS.
¥
3. Network provider does not support this feature.
4. No number or an invalid number is entered
for the SMS centre set as the active send
service centre.
Enter the number (page 58).
¥
You receive an incomplete SMS.
1. Your phone's memory is full.
Delete old SMS messages (page 56).
¥
2. The service provider has not yet sent the
rest of the SMS.
You have stopped receiving SMS messages.
1. You have changed the ID of your mailbox.
Give your SMS contacts your new ID or
undo the change (page 58).
¥
2. You have not activated your mailbox.
Activate your mailbox (page 58).
Version 4, 16.09.2005
¥
3. Call forwarding is activated with When: All
Calls for a fixed line connection, and with All
Calls for the network mailbox.
Change the call forwarding.
¥
60
¥
2. Your mobile phone operator and your fixed
line network SMS service provider have not
agreed on a co-operation.
Obtain information from your fixed line
network SMS service provider.
¥
3. Your end device has been recorded by your
SMS provider as having no fixed line network SMS functionality, i.e. you are no
longer registered with the provider.
Start the registration assistant for automatic registration (see page 53).
Have the device (re-)registered to
receive SMS messages.
¥
¥
Messages are only received during the day.
1. The terminal is recorded in your SMS provider's database as having no fixed line network SMS functionality, i.e. you are no
longer registered with the provider.
Start the registration assistant for automatic registration (see page 53).
Register the terminal (again) for SMS
reception (see above).
¥
¥
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / answering_m.fm / 27.10.08
Gigaset S675/S685 IP: operating the base station answer machine
Gigaset S675/S685 IP:
operating the base station
answer machine
You can operate the answer machine that
is integrated in the base station via the
handset or via remote operation (other
phone/mobile phone). You can record
your own announcement message or
advisory message via the handset.
Please note:
Connections to the answer machine (internal
and external) are not established using broadband.
Receive numbers
You can use your phone's Web configurator to set which of your phone numbers
your answer machine is to accept as soon
as it is switched on (page 121). You can
assign your phone any amount of phone
numbers as receive numbers (VoIP, fixed
line network, Gigaset.net).
All calls accepted by the answer machine
are stored in sequence in the answer
machine independently of the receive
number and displayed in the same answer
machine list.
Any registered handset to which at least
one receive number from the answer
machine has been assigned as a send or
receive number can access the answer
machine list (page 120).
After a new phone number is configured
(a new VoIP account), it is first assigned to
the answer machine as a receive number.
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Parallel calls
If a caller is connected to the answer
machine and a second call for the answer
machine comes in on a different line
(fixed line network or VoIP), the second
caller hears the ringing tone. The answer
machine will answer the second call if:
u the connection with the first caller has
ended and
u the set time period for the answer
machine to answer a call (page 65) has
expired.
Announce only/answer and record mode
You can use the answer machine in two
different modes.
u In Ans. & Record mode, the caller hears
the announcement and can then leave
a message.
u In Announce Only mode, the caller hears
your announcement but cannot leave a
message.
Operation via the handset
The handset loudspeaker activates automatically if you receive an acoustic
prompt or message while operating. You
can switch it off with the handsfree key
.
Activating/deactivating the answer
machine
¢ ¢ Voice Mail ¢ Local AM
¢ Ans Machine ( ‰ = on)
v
When the answer machine is activated,
the remaining memory time is
announced. If the time has not yet been
set (page 11), an appropriate announcement is made. The × icon appears in the
display.
The answer machine accepts calls for all
the receive numbers assigned to it
(page 121).
In answer and record mode
If the memory is full the answer machine
automatically switches to announce only
mode.
¤ Delete old messages.
The answer machine reverts automatically
to answer and record mode.
61
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / answering_m.fm / 27.10.08
Gigaset S675/S685 IP: operating the base station answer machine
Selecting announcement mode
You can choose between Ans. & Record and
Announce Only.
v ¢ ¢ Voice Mail ¢ Local AM
¢ Announcements ¢ Set Ans. Mode
¢ Ans. & Record / Announce Only ( ‰ = on)
Press and hold (idle status).
The selected mode is saved even after the
answer machine is deactivated.
The selection process will be cancelled if
the message memory is already full when
you change to Ans. & Record mode. You
will be requested to delete old messages.
The answer machine stays in announce
only mode Announce Only.
¤ Delete old messages.
Only after messages have been deleted
can you switch the answer machine to
answer and record mode.
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Setting "Answer & Record" or "Announce
Only" by toggling
You can use the Ans Mode Time setting to
change over the announcement mode for
a specific period.
Example: Ans. & Record mode is set. If you
activate Ans Mode Time and set the time
period From: 18:00, Until: 08:00 the
answer machine will switch to Announce
Only mode every day at 18:00 (if it is
switched on). It will switch back to Ans. &
Record mode at 08:00 the next day.
v ¢ ¢ Voice Mail ¢ Local AM
¢ Announcements ¢ Set Ans. Mode
¢ Ans Mode Time ( ‰ = on)
¤ Change multiple line input:
From:
Enter hours/minutes for the start of the
period in 4-digit format.
Until:
Enter hours/minutes for the end of the
period in 4-digit format.
Activation:
Select On or Off.
¤ Save changes with §Save§.
62
If the messages memory is full and Activation: On has been selected, saving is interrupted and you will receive an instruction
to delete old messages.
¤ Delete old messages and repeat the setting.
As soon as you change the announcement
mode (page 62), the Ans Mode Time function is automatically deactivated. You may
have to re-activate it if required.
If you do not enter a time for From: / Until:,
Ans Mode Time will still be activated but the
machine will not switch to announcement
mode.
Recording a personal announcement/
notification
Pre-recorded announcements are stored
in your telephone for both announcement
modes. The pre-recorded announcements
are used if there is no personal announcement for the mode concerned.
v ¢ ¢ Voice Mail ¢ Local AM
¢ Announcements ¢ Record Announce /
Record Anc Only
§OK§
Press the display key to start
the recording.
When the recording starts, the handset
changes to handsfree mode. You hear the
ready tone (short tone).
¤ Now speak your announcement (at
least 3 secs.).
Use or to cancel recording and
§OK§ to restart the recording process.
The recording is cancelled if the answer
machine memory is full.
¤ Delete old messages and repeat recording if required.
Stop recording:
§End§
Press the display key.
After recording, the announcement is
played back for you to check.
You can re-record the announcement with
§New§.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / answering_m.fm / 27.10.08
Gigaset S675/S685 IP: operating the base station answer machine
You can cancel playback by pressing or .
Please note:
u Recording ends automatically if the
maximum recording time of 170 seconds is exceeded or there is a break in
speech for more than 2 seconds.
u If you cancel the recording, the previously recorded announcement will be
deleted. The pre-recorded announcement will be used again.
u The recording is cancelled if the answer
machine memory is full.
¤ Delete old messages and repeat
recording if required.
u If an external call is received during a
recording for one of the handset's
receive numbers, the recording is interrupted and the call is signalled on the
handset.
Playing back announcements
v ¢ ¢ Voice Mail ¢ Local AM
¢ Announcements ¢ Play Announce /
Play Anc Only
If you have not recorded a personal
announcement, the relevant pre-recorded
announcement is played.
Record a new announcement while playing back the announcement:
§New§
Press the display key. For further information, page 62.
Deleting announcements/announce
only
¢ ¢ Voice Mail ¢ Local AM
¢ Announcements ¢ Del Announce /
v
Del Anc Only
Press the display key to confirm the prompt.
Press and hold (idle status).
Version 4, 16.09.2005
§Yes§
Once you have deleted your announcement, the relevant pre-recorded
announcement will be used again. You
cannot delete the pre-recorded announcements.
Playing back messages
New messages that have not yet been
heard are indicated by the icon in the
display and by the key flashing on the
handset.
You can start to play back the messages in
two ways:
u Open the answer machine list with the
message key.
u If the answer machine is set for fast
access (page 66): press and hold key
.
Please note:
All messages are played back irrespective of
their receive number.
Listening to messages via the answer
machine list
Precondition: At least one of your handset's send/receive numbers matches the
receive number of a stored message.
The date and time of each message is
logged in the answer machine list (provided it has been set, page 11) and displayed during the playback. If Calling Line
Identification is activated, the caller's
number is displayed. If the caller's number
is saved in the directory, their name is displayed.
Press the message key.
Ans M.:
Select and press §OK§.
An announcement informs you if there are
new or old messages.
If there are new messages, playback
begins with the first new message. If the
message has been saved with the date
and time, you will hear an appropriate
announcement before playback begins.
All messages are played back irrespective
of the receive number.
63
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / answering_m.fm / 27.10.08
Gigaset S675/S685 IP: operating the base station answer machine
After the last new message you will hear
the end tone and an announcement about
how much recording time remains.
You can listen to old messages if there are
no more new messages. Begin playback as
described above.
Copying the phone number of a message
to the directory
Listening to messages via key Preconditions: The answer machine has
been set to fast access (page 66). At least
one of your handset's send/receive numbers matches the receive number of a
stored message (page 121).
¤ Press and hold key .
The stored messages are now played back.
You can either delete all old messages
together or individually.
Pausing and controlling playback
During message playback:
Pause playback. Press again to resume.
or Skip to the previous message.
or 3
Skip to the next message.
2x
Skip to next-but-one message.
If playback is interrupted for over a
minute, the answer machine returns to
idle status.
Marking a message as "new"
Version 4, 16.09.2005
A previously played back "old" message is
displayed as a "new" message again.
During message playback or pause:
Press the star key.
Or:
§Options§
Open menu.
Mark as New
Select and press §OK§.
Playback of the current message is cancelled. Playback of next message starts, if
applicable.
The key on the handset flashes.
64
See "Copying a displayed number to the
directory", page 44.
Deleting messages
Deleting all old messages
During playback or pause:
§Options§
Press the display key.
Del All Old Msgs
Select and press §OK§.
§Yes§
Press the display key to confirm the prompt.
All old messages are deleted irrespective
of the receive number.
Deleting individual old messages
During playback or pause:
§Delete§ / Q
Press the display key or Q
key.
Please note:
You can delete a new message as soon as playback has started.
Picking up a call from the answer
machine
You can pick up a call while the answer
machine is recording or is being operated
via remote operation:
/ §Accept§
Press the talk or display key.
Recording stops and you can speak to the
caller.
If 3 seconds of the call have already been
recorded when you pick it up, the call will
be displayed as a new message. The key on the handset flashes.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / answering_m.fm / 27.10.08
Gigaset S675/S685 IP: operating the base station answer machine
Forwarding an external call to the
answer machine
the end tone is then allocated to the
answer machine list as a new message.
You can forward an incoming external call
to the answer machine.
Preconditions: There is sufficient free
memory space. One of your handset's
send/receive numbers matches a receive
number of the answer machine.
An external call is signalled on the
handset:
Ÿ
Press the display key.
The answer machine starts immediately in
recording mode and records the call. The
set time for the call acceptance (page 65)
is ignored.
The display key Ÿ will not be displayed if the memory is full.
Please note:
Activating/deactivating two-way
recording
You can record an external call with the
answer machine.
Precondition: You are conducting an
external call. At least one of the handset's
send/receive numbers is assigned to the
answer machine as a receive number
(page 121).
¤ Inform the caller that the call is being
recorded.
Press the display key.
Two Way Record
Select and press §OK§.
The two-way recording is indicated on the
display by an advisory text and is added to
the answer machine list as a new message.
§End§
Press the display key to stop
the two-way recording.
The maximum recording time depends on
the memory available on the answer
machine. If the memory is full, you will
hear an end tone and the recording is
aborted. The conversation recorded up to
Version 4, 16.09.2005
§Options§
You can activate two-way recording for conference calls and toggling when making calls via
a fixed line network.
Activating/deactivating call
screening
During recording of a message you can
screen a call via the handset loudspeaker.
Precondition: The number called is
assigned to the handset as a receive
number (page 120).
Permanently activating/deactivating
call screening
v ¢ ¢ Voice Mail ¢ Local AM
Call Screening
Select and press §OK§ ( ‰ = on)
Press and hold (idle status).
Deactivating call screening for the
current recording
You can deactivate the Call Screening function for the current call during recording
via the handset.
Briefly press the end call key.
Setting up the answer machine
The answer machine has already been
preset at the factory. Make individual settings using the handset.
Call acceptance/charge saving
function for remote operation
You can set when you want the answer
machine to accept a call.
The options are: 0 sec., after 10 sec., 18 sec.
or 30 sec. and the cost-saving setting
Automatic.
65
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / answering_m.fm / 27.10.08
Gigaset S675/S685 IP: operating the base station answer machine
In Automatic mode, the following applies
for call acceptance:
u If there are no new messages, the
answer machine accepts a call after
18 seconds.
u If new messages are present, the
answer machine accepts a call after
10 seconds.
When operating remotely you can tell
after approx. 15 seconds that there are no
new messages (otherwise the answer
machine would already have accepted
your call). There will be no call charges if
you hang up now.
v ¢ ¢ Voice Mail ¢ Local AM
¢ Ring Delay
Select 0 sec. / 10 sec. / 18 sec. /
30 sec. / Automatic.
§Save§
Press the display key.
Press and hold (idle status).
Setting the recording time
You can set the maximum recording time
of a message. You can choose between:
60 Sec, 120 Sec, 180 Sec or Maximum.
v ¢ ¢ Voice Mail ¢ Local AM
¢ Message Length
Select the recording time.
§Save§
Press the display key.
Setting the recording quality
Set the quality you require for your recordings. The options are: Standard, High, Excellent. If the quality is higher, the maximum
recording time is reduced.
v ¢ ¢ Voice Mail ¢ Local AM
¢ Record Quality
Select the recording quality.
§Save§
Press the display key.
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Please note:
Your announcements are always recorded in
best quality.
66
Configuring the network mailbox
for fast access
You can assign the local answer machine
or one of your network mailboxes to key
for fast access (page 79). This setting
is handset-specific.
Configuring the local answer machine for
fast access
Precondition: At least one of your handset's send/receive numbers matches a
receive number of the answer machine.
v ¢ ¢ Voice Mail ¢ Set Key 1
Local AM Select and press §OK§.
Press and hold (idle status).
Listening to messages on the answer
machine
Precondition: The answer machine is set
for fast access on the handset.
Press and hold.
The messages are now played back.
Hands-free operation is activated. You will
hear the answer machine announcement.
If necessary, press the handsfree button to switch it off.
Operating when on the move
(remote operation)
You can check and activate your answer
machine from any other telephone (hotel,
pay phone etc.), or initiate ringback from
the answer machine with an SMS.
Preconditions:
u You have set a system PIN other than
0000 (page 96).
u The phone you are using for remote
operation has touch tone dialling
(DTMF), i.e. you hear different tones
when you press the keys. Alternatively,
you can use a code transmitter (available from your mobile phone retailer).
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / answering_m.fm / 27.10.08
Gigaset S675/S685 IP: operating the base station answer machine
Please note:
Remote operation via VoIP connections is possible as long as DTMF signals are transmitted
(depending on the provider) as SIP info messages, audible signals in the voice channel
(inband or audio) or as special RTP data packets (pursuant to RFC2833).
Calling the answer machine and
playing back messages
Precondition: Your answer machine is
activated.
Dial your own number that is
assigned to the answer
machine as a receive number.
9
When you hear your
announcement, press 9 and
enter the system PIN.
You will be informed whether any new
messages have been recorded. The messages are now played back. All messages
are played back irrespective of their
receive number. After the new messages,
the old messages are played back. Finally,
the remaining memory time is given.
You can control message playback by
means of the keypad.
Please note:
Version 4, 16.09.2005
The answer machine will terminate the connection under the following circumstances:
– An incorrect system PIN has been entered.
– There are no messages in the answer
machine
– After the remaining memory announcement
Operating the answer machine via the
keypad
The following keys are used for operation:
(
Previous:
Go to the start of the current
message. Press repeatedly to
go to the previous messages.
)
Stop/resume:
Stop playback. Press again to
resume.
If there is a pause lasting
longer than one minute, the
connection to the answer
machine is terminated.
3
Next:
Skip to next message. Press
several times to go to the following messages.
:
New:
Mark current message as
"new". Start playback of the
following message.
0
Delete:
Delete current message.
Cancelling remote operation
¤ Press the end call key or replace the
receiver.
Activating the answer machine
¤ Phone home and allow the phone to
ring for around a minute. Use a phone
number that has been assigned to the
answer machine as a receive number.
You hear: "Please enter PIN".
Enter system PIN.
Your answer machine will be activated in
the set mode (page 62). It tells you how
much memory time is left.
The messages are now played back.
The answer machine cannot be deactivated remotely.
67
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / email.fm / 27.10.08
E-mail notifications
E-mail notifications
Your phone will notify you when new email messages have been received on
your incoming e-mail server.
You can set your phone to periodically
connect to your incoming e-mail server
and check whether you have new e-mail.
Any new messages that have been
received are displayed on all Gigaset
S67H/S68H handsets that have been registered: you will hear an advisory tone, the
message key will flash and the ' icon
will be displayed in the idle display.
Please note:
The ' icon is also displayed if new SMS messages or messenger messages have been
received.
If new e-mail messages have been received,
pressing the message key will display
them in the E-mail: list.
You can use your phone to connect to the
incoming e-mail server and display the
sender, date and time of receipt and subject for every e-mail message in the list of
incoming mail (page 68).
Preconditions:
u You have set up an e-mail account with
Version 4, 16.09.2005
an Internet provider.
u The incoming e-mail server uses the
POP3 protocol.
u You have stored the name of the
incoming e-mail server and your personal access data (account name, password) in the phone (page 128).
68
Opening the incoming e-mail list
v ¢ ¢ E-mail
Or if new e-mail messages have been
received (the message key is flashing):
¢ E-mail:
The telephone establishes a connection to
the incoming e-mail server. A list of e-mail
messages that are stored there will be displayed.
New unread messages appear above old
read messages. The most recent entry is at
the head of the list.
The following details are displayed for
each e-mail: name or e-mail address of the
sender (one line, abbreviated if necessary)
and date and time (date and time will only
display correct values if sender and recipient are located in the same time zone).
Example display:
Inbox
1
2
Susi Sorglos
15.01.08
12:20
Louise Miller
15.01.08
11:15
Options
1 E-mail address or name transmitted by the
sender
Bold: New message.
2 Date and time of receipt of e-mail message
If the incoming message list on the incoming e-mail server is empty, No entries will
appear in the display.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / email.fm / 27.10.08
E-mail notifications
Please note:
Many e-mail providers operate standard spam
protection measures. E-mail messages classified as spam are stored in a separate folder and
are therefore not shown on the list of incoming mail.
Some e-mail providers allow you to deactivate
spam protection or show spam e-mails on the
list of incoming mail.
Other e-mail providers may send a message to
the Inbox when a new spam e-mail is received.
This is to inform you that a suspected spam email has been received.
Date and sender of this mail are repeatedly
updated, so that it is always displayed as a new
message.
Messages when establishing a connection
Version 4, 16.09.2005
The following problems may occur when
connecting to the incoming e-mail server.
The messages are displayed in the handset's display for a few seconds.
Server not accessible!
The connection to the incoming e-mail
server could not be established. This
may have the following causes:
– Incorrect entry for name of incoming e-mail server.
– Temporary problems with the
incoming e-mail server (server is
down or is not connected to the
Internet).
¤ Check settings (page 128).
¤ Try again later.
Currently not possible!
The resources your phone requires to
make the connection are busy, e.g.:
– Two VoIP connections have already
been made.
– Another handset is currently connected to the incoming e-mail
server.
¤ Try again later.
Log-in failed!
Error when logging in to the incoming
e-mail server. This may have the following cause:
– Incorrect entries for name of incoming e-mail server, user name and/or
password.
¤ Check settings (page 128).
Mailbox settings incomplete!
Incomplete entries for name of incoming e-mail server, user name and/or
password.
¤ Check settings and complete if necessary (page 128).
Viewing the message header of
an e-mail
Precondition: You have opened the
incoming mail list (page 68).
Select e-mail entry.
§Subject§
Press the display key.
The subject of the e-mail message will be
displayed (max. 120 characters).
Press the display key to return
to the incoming message list.
Please note:
If the header is formatted in HTML it may be
displayed differently to headers on the PC email client.
69
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / email.fm / 27.10.08
E-mail notifications
Viewing an e-mail sender's
address
Precondition: You have opened the
incoming mail list (page 68).
Select e-mail entry.
§From§
Press the display key.
The sender's e-mail address is shown in
full.
Press the display key to return
to the incoming message list.
Example:
From
Susi.Sorglos@mailp
rov.com
Options
Deleting an e-mail
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Precondition: You have viewed the message header or the sender's address of an
e-mail (page 69).
¤ Select §Options§ ¢ Delete E-mail and press
§OK§.
The e-mail is deleted from the incoming email server.
70
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / messenger.fm / 27.10.08
Messenger
Messenger
The messenger on your phone makes
instant messaging possible (immediate
message transfer, chatting). The phone
supports the XMPP messenger (Jabber).
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Instant messaging refers to communication between "friends" on the Internet.
Subscribers exchange short messages,
which are forwarded immediately. This
gives rise to a flowing "conversation" similar to chatting.
The precondition for this form of communication is that both subscribers have a
connection to the messenger server of
the same instant messaging provider.
Therefore, both subscribers must be
"online". The messenger server forwards
the messages to the recipient.
The subscribers to instant messaging are
called buddies.
Most messenger servers allow you to create what are known as buddy lists. You
can store the buddies you want to chat to
in the buddy list.
The messenger server informs you as soon
as one of your buddies comes online or
goes offline. Offline means that the
buddy has disconnected from the messenger server.
In addition to this, each buddy can determine their own (communication) status
(state of presence, see page 73), from
which buddies can tell whether they are in
the mood to chat or wish to remain undisturbed.
u Exchange messages with your buddies.
Your handset notifies you about new
messages with a flashing message key
and a beep.
u Call your buddies directly from your
buddy list (page 77).
Preconditions for instant messaging:
u You have registered with an instant
messaging provider via the Web
browser on your PC and (optionally)
agreed a Web name (nickname).
u You have created a buddy list via the
messenger client on the PC.
u You have saved the messenger server
address and your access data for the
messenger server (user ID, password)
in the phone using the Web configurator (page 126). The phone needs the
data to establish a connection with the
messenger server.
Please note:
If your instant messaging provider doesn't support the phone's messenger client, then you
can open an account with an open Jabber
server and use the Web configurator to enter
its address in your phone. Many of these Jabber servers offer gateways to other messenger
servers (e.g. AOL, ICQ, MSN, Yahoo!).
You can find a list of Jabber servers and an
overview of the gateways to other messenger
servers on the Internet at
http://www.jabber.org.
You can find information on setting up a Jabber account with connections from ICQ, MSN
or Yahoo on the Internet, e.g. at:
http://web.swissjabber.ch
The Web configurator on your phone gives
you the following options:
u Go online (page 72).
u Display the list of your contacts (buddies) on the handset that you previously created on the PC. This will indicate for each buddy whether they are
available (online) and ready to chat
(state of presence, see page 73).
71
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / messenger.fm / 27.10.08
Messenger
Establishing a connection,
going online
When you go online, your buddy list will
be displayed on the handset and you will
receive messages from your buddies.
Only one of the handsets connected to the
base station can connect to the messenger server. You can then only "chat" on this
handset.
An external call will interrupt the "chat",
but you will still be online. You can continue your chat after you end or reject the
call.
Precondition: You have saved the messenger server address and your access
data for the messenger server (user ID and
password) in the phone using the Web
configurator (page 126).
v ¢ ¢ Messenger
Press the display key to confirm the prompt.
The phone attempts to establish a connection. You are informed about the status of
the connection by messages on the display.
If the connection can be established, you
are Online . The display will show the submenu for your messenger. You can open
your buddy list, send and receive messages and call your buddies.
The following is displayed when the handset is in idle status.
§Yes§
Ð
V
INT 1
%
Version 4, 16.09.2005
15.01.08
?
72
09:45
SMS
You remain online until you set your status
to Offline (page 73) or the connection to
the messenger server is terminated
(page 77).
You also remain online if you press the end
call key .
If the connection cannot be established,
you will receive an appropriate message.
Please try again later (page 77).
Please note:
You can also assign the messenger to one of
the display keys on your handset (page 87).
The connection is established when you press
the display key.
Lost connection
If your phone loses its connection to the
messenger server, the display key will
flash on the handset that had been connected to the messenger. In idle status it
will display "Messenger connection failed!".
All messages that you had previously
received, as well as any message you were
currently writing, will be saved.
Reconnecting:
Press the message key.
§Yes§
Press the display key to confirm the prompt.
The phone will attempt to reconnect. You
are informed about the status of the connection by messages on the display.
If you reply to the request with §No§ the
phone will behave as during regular disconnection. All messenger messages will
be deleted. The phone is offline.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / messenger.fm / 27.10.08
Messenger
Changing/checking your
personal status, going offline
You want to log off (go offline) or let your
buddies know whether you wish to chat or
would prefer to remain undisturbed.
You have the following options:
Offline
You log off from the messenger server.
The messenger server informs your
buddies that you are no longer available.
The handset switches to idle status.
You can neither send nor receive messages.
Online
(Setting after successful connection)
You are logged on to the messenger
server and can send and receive messages.
Ready for chat
You are Online and can send and
receive messages.
You invite your buddies to "chat" with
you.
Away / Extended Away / Do not disturb
You are Online and can send and
receive messages. You inform your
buddies that you currently cannot/do
not wish to "chat", i.e. will not reply to
their messages immediately.
Invisible
You are Online and can send and
receive messages.
However, the messenger server indicates to your buddies that you are
Offline .
Changing status
v ¢ ¢ Messenger ¢ User Status
¢ Change Status
Select status and press §OK§
( ‰ = on).
Press and hold if necessary
(idle status).
Disconnecting, going offline
¤ Select Offline
status, and respond
§Yes§.to the security prompt.
The connection to the messenger server
will be terminated. The handset returns to
idle status. New messenger messages are
no longer sent to you. The messenger
message list is deleted. The buddy list is no
longer available.
Please note:
Whether messages directed to you are deleted
or stored in the messenger server depends on
the provider. Stored messages are sent to you
when you go online again.
Checking your status and user ID
v ¢ ¢ Messenger ¢ User Status
¢ Info
If you are online, the following information may be displayed (depending on your
provider):
u Your Web name (nickname, abbreviated if necessary)
u Your current status
u Your user ID (format: userid@providerdomain; abbreviated if necessary)
Only Offline will be displayed if you are
offline.
Please note:
Version 4, 16.09.2005
All status settings apart from Offline only
inform other buddies about your communication status. Whether this information is passed
on to your buddies depends on the provider.
73
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / messenger.fm / 27.10.08
Messenger
Opening the buddy list
Precondition: You are Online and have
already created a buddy list (using the PC)
on your provider's messenger server.
v ¢ ¢ Messenger ¢ Buddies
Only the first 20 (maximum) buddies on
the buddy list will be read by the messenger server and displayed on the handset.
The number depends on the available
memory space.
3. Buddies with Offline or Invisible status in
alphabetical order. The % icon is red.
Please note:
The buddy list will remain open until you exit it
(briefly press or press and hold ).
The handset will not automatically return to
idle status.
Changes in the status of buddies
You can also receive and respond to messages
from buddies who are not on the list displayed
on the handset.
You have opened the buddy list and one of
the buddies changes their status. The following distinctions are made:
u A buddy changes to status Online /
Ready for chat :
You are informed via a message on the
display. The buddy list is updated.
u In the event of another status change,
the buddy list is updated. No message
is displayed.
Example:
Please note:
The buddies that are displayed depend on
which buddies were transferred from the
messenger server first.
Please note:
Buddies
Mark
Julian
Lisa
Herbert
%
%
&
&
If the buddy changes to Offline status, your
messages are no longer sent to them. Whether
the messenger server stores the messages
until the buddy is Online again or deletes them
depends on the provider.
Requesting information about buddies
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Chat
Info
The Web names (nicknames) of your buddies are displayed on the list. If they do not
have a Web name, the user ID is displayed.
If the name of a buddy is longer than one
line, it will be abbreviated. You can navigate in the list with the control key .
The buddies appear on the list in the following order. Their status (page 73) is
identifiable by the colour of the % icon
next to the buddies:
1. Buddies with Online status or Ready for
chat in alphabetical order. The % icon is
green.
2. Buddies with Away , Extended Away or
Do not disturb status in alphabetical order. The % icon is orange.
74
You have opened the buddy list (page 74).
Select buddy.
§Info§
Press the display key.
The display depends on the provider.
Example:
Info
Julian
Online
Julian.Reeves@jabbe
r.com
1
2
3
Chat
1 Web name (nickname, abbreviated if necessary)
2 Status
3 User ID (format: userid@provider-domain;
abbreviated if necessary). (Resource names
are not displayed)
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / messenger.fm / 27.10.08
Messenger
If the buddy changes their status the entry
is updated.
Press to return to your buddy list. Press
§Chat§ if you want to "chat" with the buddy.
To open the message list from the menu:
Chatting to buddies
Message list
You want to "chat" to a buddy, i.e. send a
message.
Precondition: You have opened the
buddy list (page 74) and selected a buddy
with .
¤ Press the display key §Chat§. The text editor is opened.
¤ Write and send your message
(page 76).
The buddy list is shown again.
The messages on the list are sorted chronologically, with the oldest message at the
head of the list.
Example of a list display:
Receiving messages
Precondition: You are online.
Newly arrived buddy or info messages
(page 75) are indicated by a flashing message key and a beep, even if you are
in a messenger menu or text editor.
The messages are stored in the Messenger:
message list.
Please note:
The Messenger list is only displayed if you are
online.
Opening the message list using the key
The message key flashes.
¤ Press the message key .
¤ Select Messenger: (2) list if required and
press §OK§. The number in brackets indicates the number of new messages.
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Please note:
If you are in the messenger menu or one of
its submenus/text editors and you press the
flashing message key , this will open the
Messenger list directly.
In the handset idle status:
v ¢ ¢ Messenger ¢ Messages
Select and press §OK§.
Messenger
Julian
15.01.08
15:25
INFO message
15.01.08
15:30
Delete
1
2
3
Read
1 Sender's Web name/user ID
Bold: new/unread message
2 Date and time of message
3 Message from the messenger server
(page 75)
If the memory is full and new messages
arrive, the oldest message(s) will be overwritten. If there are no old (read) messages, the oldest new (unread) messages
will be overwritten.
Message types
In instant messaging, a distinction is made
between the following types of message:
u Buddy messages are the "instant messages" you receive from other buddies.
You can answer the messages.
u Info messages are special information
from the provider. They are forwarded
to you, but you cannot reply to them.
Example: With some messaging providers you receive an info message
when another subscriber tries to add
you to their buddy list. You are
prompted to check the messages on
the messenger client on your PC.
75
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / messenger.fm / 27.10.08
Messenger
Via the messenger client on your PC
you can agree to the action or refuse
permission. Without your agreement,
the other subscriber cannot add you to
their buddy list.
Reading messages
Precondition: You have opened the message list and selected a message with .
¤ Press the display key §Read§.
The message is opened for you to read.
You have the following options:
§Delete§
Delete a message from the list.
You will return to the message
list.
Or:
§Answer§
(for buddy messages only)
Reply to message. The text
editor is opened. You can write
a reply (see "Writing and sending messages" on page 76).
Or:
Back to the message list.
Delete message
Precondition: You have opened the message list and selected a message with .
¤ Press the display key §Delete§.
Writing and sending messages
Precondition:
u You are reading a buddy's message and
press the display key §Answer§ or
u You have pressed the display key §Chat§
in the buddy list or the buddy profiles.
A text editor is opened.
¤ Use the handset keys to enter a message (max. 612 characters).
¤ Select ©§ ¢ Send and press §OK§.
Version 4, 16.09.2005
The message is sent to the buddy.
76
Please note:
– Entering text with and without EATONI predictive text is described from page 148.
– EATONI is activated as a default setting.
How to activate/deactivate EATONI, see
page 149.
If the messenger server is unable to send
the message to the buddy, a message will
be displayed.
¤ Confirm the message by clicking §OK§.
The text-editor will re-open with your
message. You can then retry sending the
message.
Interruption while writing
If you receive a call/SMS while you are
writing a message or the connection to
the messenger server is interrupted, the
text editor is terminated and the text written so far is lost.
Menu options for the text editor
By pressing © within the text editor you
have the following options:
Send
Send message to buddy.
Delete Text
Delete the whole text.
Predictive Text
Activate/deactivate predictive text see
page 148.
Select Language
For predictive text: select the language
in which you wish to write the text and
press §OK§.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / messenger.fm / 27.10.08
Messenger
Calling a buddy
Errors when sending
You can call a buddy directly.
Precondition: The messenger server supports calls using vCard and your buddy's
vCard contains a phone number.
If it is not possible to send a message, a
distinction is made between the following
situations:
u The connection to the messenger
server is interrupted:
A message is shown in the display to
indicate that the connection to the
messenger server has been interrupted.
The message is stored temporarily
(page 76).
¤ Try to re-establish the connection
(page 72) and send the message
again.
u The server is unable to send the message:
A message is shown in the display to
indicate that the message could not be
sent. If, for example, the buddy is not
available, the message you have sent
will also be displayed.
The message is stored temporarily
(page 76).
¤ If necessary, check the buddy's user
ID and send the message again later.
Preconditions:
u You have opened the buddy list and
selected a buddy
or
u You have opened the buddy's profile
or
u You have opened the Messenger: list
and selected a buddy
or
u You are reading a message from a
buddy
/ Briefly press or press and
hold the talk or handsfree key.
The phone will try to establish a VoIP/fixed
line connection.
The first number that is found on the
vCard will be dialled.
Ending a call
Press the end call key.
Self-help with errors
While establishing a connection to the
messenger server, during connection and
when sending messages the following
errors may occur.
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Behaviour when the connection is lost
If the connection to the messenger server
is interrupted, an appropriate message is
shown in the display. You are Offline .
If you are in a submenu of the messenger,
the handset switches to the messenger
menu.
¤ Try to re-establish the connection
(page 72).
77
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / T-NetBox_SAG-registration.fm / 27.10.08
Using the network mailbox
Using the network mailbox
Some fixed line network providers and
VoIP providers offer answer machines on
the network – these are known as network
mailboxes.
Each network mailbox accepts incoming
calls made via the corresponding line
(fixed line network or corresponding VoIP
phone number). To record all calls, you
should therefore set up network mailboxes for both the fixed line network and
for each of your VoIP connections.
You need to have requested the network
mailbox for your fixed line network connection from your fixed line network provider. You can store the phone number for
the fixed line network mailbox in the base
station.
You can activate/deactivate the network
mailboxes for your VoIP connections using
your handset or the Web configurator. To
do this, you only require the network mailbox phone number.
Activating/deactivating the
network mailbox, entering
numbers
Version 4, 16.09.2005
You can manage the network mailboxes
on your handset that are assigned to a
receive number on the handset.
v ¢ Settings ¢ Voice Mail
¢ Network AM(s)
The list of connections (VoIP and fixed line
network) that are assigned to the handset
as receive numbers is displayed. The display shows Net AM: xxx, where xxx is
replaced by the relevant default name for
the connection (IP1 to IP6, Fxd. line ).
Select connection and press
§OK§.
78
You have selected a VoIP connection:
¤ Change multiple line input:
Status
Select On to activate the network mailbox. Select Off to deactivate.
Number
The number that is currently stored for
the network mailbox is displayed.
Enter or change the phone number for
the network mailbox if necessary.
With some VoIP providers your network
mailbox phone number will be downloaded together with the general VoIP
provider data (page 112), saved to your
base station and displayed under
Number.
You have selected the fixed line network
connection:
Number
Enter or change the phone number for
the network mailbox.
You cannot activate/deactivate the network mailbox for the fixed line network
connection via the handset. For how to
activate/deactivate the network mailbox
for the fixed line network connection
please refer to the fixed line network provider's information.
Please note:
For information on how to activate and deactivate network mailboxes via the Web configurator and to change their assigned numbers, see,
see page 126.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / T-NetBox_SAG-registration.fm / 27.10.08
Using the network mailbox
Configuring the (network)
mailbox for fast access
You can use fast access to make direct calls
to a network mailbox or, for the Gigaset
S675/S685 IP, also the integrated answer
machine on the base station.
Assigning key 1 of the handset,
changing assignments
Version 4, 16.09.2005
The setting for fast access is handset-specific. You can assign a different answer
machine to key on each registered
handset.
No answer machine is preconfigured for
fast access in the default settings.
Fast access is not yet set on the
handset: Press and hold key
.
Or:
v ¢ Settings ¢ Voice Mail
¢ Set Key 1
The list of connections (VoIP and fixed line
network) that are assigned to the handset
as receive numbers is displayed. The display shows Net AM: xxx, where xxx is
replaced by the relevant default name for
the connection (IP1 to IP6, Fxd. line ).
Gigaset S675/S685 IP: For the integrated
answer machine of the base station, the
entry Local AM is offered in the list (see
page 66).
Select entry and press §OK§
( ‰ = on).
You will be prompted to enter the number
for the network mailbox.
Jump to the Number line.
Enter the number for the network mailbox.
§Save§
Press the display key.
Press and hold (idle status).
Fast access is automatically activated.
Please note:
You can only assign fast access to one answer
machine.
However, you can also call the network mailbox assigned to a handset's receive numbers
directly via the message key (page 80).
Calling the network mailbox
Press and hold.
If you have set a network mailbox for fast
access you will be connected straight to
this network mailbox.
If necessary, press the handsfree key.
You hear the network mailbox announcement.
Gigaset S675/S685 IP: If you have set the
integrated answer machine on the base
station for fast access, message playback
begins (see page 66).
When selecting a network mailbox:
If a number is already saved to the base
station for the network mailbox, fast
access is activated.
Press and hold (idle status).
If no number has been saved for the network mailbox, a message is displayed to
this effect.
79
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / T-NetBox_SAG-registration.fm / 27.10.08
Using the network mailbox
Listening to messages on the
network mailbox
Under the message key you will find a
list for each network mailbox that fulfils
the following requirements:
u The corresponding connections are
allocated to the handset as receive
numbers.
u The network mailbox phone number is
saved on the base station.
You can call and check the network mailbox directly from the list.
When you press the message key , the
following is displayed (example):
Messages & Calls
Calls List:
(4)
Net AM: IP1
(1)
Net AM: Fxd. line
Net AM: IP2
(2)
(0)
OK
1
2
3
1 "Fxd. line ", "IP1" etc. are the default names
for the associated connections. The default
names are always shown irrespective of
which connection name you have specified
when configuring via the Web configurator.
2 If there are new messages in the network
mailbox, the list entry is shown in bold. The
number of new messages is shown in brackets following the list entry.
3 If there are no new messages (0) is shown
after the list entry for the network mailbox.
The number of messages stored in the network mailbox is not displayed.
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Displaying new messages in the handset's
idle status
If a new message is present on one of the
network mailboxes to which the handset
is allocated via its receive number, or there
is a new message on the integrated
answer machine, the icon and the
number of new messages are shown on
the handset's idle display. The message key flashes.
80
Calling the network mailbox and checking
messages
Press the message key.
Net AM: Fxd. line / Net AM: IP1 / etc.
Select the network mailbox
and press §OK§.
You are connected directly to the network
mailbox and hear its announcement. Messages can generally be played back using
your handset keypad (digit codes). Listen
to the announcement.
Please note:
– The network mailbox is automatically
called via the corresponding connection.
An area code predefined for your phone is
not prefixed.
– Network mailbox messages can generally
be played back using your handset keypad
(digit codes). You need to define how the
digit codes for VoIP should be converted to
DTMF signals and transmitted (page 122).
Ask your VoIP provider which type of DTMF
transmission it supports.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / T-NetBox_SAG-registration.fm / 27.10.08
Using several handsets
Using several handsets
Registering another Gigaset S67H/
S68H handset on the Gigaset S685/
S675 IP
Registering handsets
Before you can use your handset, you
must register it to a base station.
You must initiate handset registration on
the handset and on the base station.
If the handset has been registered successfully, the handset returns to idle status. The handset's internal number is
shown in the display e.g. Int 1. If not,
repeat the procedure. Registration can
take up to one minute.
You can register up to six handsets to your
base station.
You can register your Gigaset S67H/S68H
handset on up to four base stations.
When you register a new Gigaset handset,
the base station transfers the following
entries to its local directory to enable you
to use online directories on your new
handset:
u Net Directory for the currently active
online directory (page 129)
u Yellow Pages for the currently active
classified directory (page 129)
u Gigaset.net for the Gigaset.net directory
Precondition: The handset can send and
receive directory entries (see handset
operating instructions).
Successful registration is acknowledged
with a Data Transfer x entries received for
this reason.
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Please note:
– If a number of handsets are registered on
your base station, you can simultaneously
make two calls via the Internet and one via
the fixed line network. Up to two additional
internal connections are also possible.
– Selecting the connection via the talk key
(page 26) is not supported on GAP handsets. Therefore, if you enter a number without a line suffix and without defining a dialling plan for the phone number, it will be
dialled via Default Line (page 98). If you
enter a "*" (star) at the end of the phone
number, it will be dialled via the nondefault connection.
– After registration, all the phone numbers
for the phone will be assigned to the handset as receive numbers. It will use the fixed
line network number and the first VoIP
number as send numbers. For how to
change the assignments, see page 120.
¤ Select v ¢ ¢ Handset
¢ Register H/Set on the handset.
¤ Enter the system PIN of the base station
(the default is 0000) and press §OK§. The
display shows e.g. Base 1 and flashes.
¤ Within the next 60 seconds, press and
hold (for approx. 3 seconds) the registration/paging key (page 2) on the
base station.
The handset is given the lowest available
internal number (1–6). If a number of
handsets are registered on the base station, the internal number appears in the
display after registration, e.g. INT 2. This
means that the internal number 2 was
assigned to the handset.
Please note:
If six handsets are already registered to the
base station, there are two options:
– The handset with the internal number 6 is
in idle status: the handset you wish to register is assigned the number 6. The handset
that was previously number 6 is de-registered.
– The handset with the internal number 6 is
being used: the handset you wish to register cannot be registered.
81
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / T-NetBox_SAG-registration.fm / 27.10.08
Using several handsets
Registering other handsets on the
Gigaset S685/S675 IP
You can register other Gigaset handsets
and handsets for other devices with GAP
functionality as follows.
¤ Begin the registration procedure on
the handset in accordance with the
handset's operating instructions.
¤ Press and hold (for approx. 3 seconds)
the registration/paging key (page 2) on
the base station.
Please note:
You can also make changes on your base station with a Gigaset S45 and C47H handset.
Locating a handset ("paging")
You can locate your handset using the
base station.
¤ Briefly press the registration/paging
key on the base station (page 2).
¤ All handsets will ring at the same time
("paging"), even if ringer tones are
switched off.
The current (local) IP address for the base
station appears in the handset displays.
Ending paging
¤ Briefly press the registration/paging
key on the base station (page 2).
Or
De-registering handsets
Version 4, 16.09.2005
You can de-register any registered handset
from any registered Gigaset S67H/S68H
handset.
Open list of internal parties.
The handset you are currently
using is highlighted with <.
Select the handset to be deregistered.
§Options§
Press the display key.
De-reg. H/Set No.
Select and press §OK§.
Enter the base station system
PIN (default setting: 0000).
§Yes§
Press the display key to confirm the prompt.
Press and hold (idle status).
The handset is de-registered immediately,
even if it is not in idle status.
82
¤ Press the talk key or the end call
key on a handset.
Changing the base station
If your handset is registered to more than
one base station, you can set it to a particular base station or to the base station
that has the best reception (Best Base).
v ¢ ¢ Handset ¢ Select Base
Select one of the registered
base stations or Best Base and
press §OK§.
Changing a handset's
internal number
A handset is automatically assigned the
lowest free number on registration. In the
list of internal parties, the handsets are
sorted according to their internal number.
You can change the internal number of all
registered handsets (1-6). Numbers 1–6
can only be assigned once each.
Open list of handsets. Your
own handset is indicated by <.
§Options§
Press the display key.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / T-NetBox_SAG-registration.fm / 27.10.08
Using several handsets
Edit H/Set No.
Select and press §OK§. The list of
handsets and their internal
numbers will be displayed.
The internal number for the
first handset flashes.
Select handset.
Enter the new internal number
(1-6). The handset's old
number is overwritten.
If necessary, select further
handsets and change numbers.
After all the changes are completed:
§Save§
Press the display key to save
the input.
Press and hold (idle status).
You will hear the error tone if an internal
number has been allocated twice.
¤ Repeat the procedure with a free
number.
Making internal calls
Changing the name of a handset
The names "INT 1", "INT 2" etc. are assigned
automatically at registration. You can
change these names. The changed name
is displayed in every handset's list.
Open list of handsets. Your
own handset is indicated by <.
Select handset.
§Edit§
Press the display key.
X
Delete previous name if necessary.
Enter the new name
(max. 10 characters).
§Save§
Press the display key.
Press and hold (idle status).
Please note:
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Please note:
If you delete the current handset name and
then press §Save§ without entering a new name,
the handset will automatically be allocated the
standard name "INT x" (x= internal number).
Internal calls to other handsets registered
on the same base station are free.
They will always be made via broadband if
both handsets are broadband-capable.
Calling a specific handset
Initiate internal call.
Enter the number of the handset.
Or:
Initiate internal call.
Select handset.
Press the talk key.
Calling all handsets ("group call")
Initiate internal call.
Press the star key. All handsets
are called.
Ending a call
Press the end call key.
You can reject an internal call by pressing the
end call key .
Other handsets will continue to signal an internal "group call".
Transferring a call to another handset
You can forward (connect) an external
call, made via fixed line network or VoIP, to
another handset.
Open the list of handsets.
The external participant hears
hold music if activated
(page 97).
Select handset or Call All and
press §OK§.
When the internal participant answers:
¤ If necessary announce the external call.
Press the end call key.
The external call is transferred to the other
handset.
83
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / T-NetBox_SAG-registration.fm / 27.10.08
Using several handsets
If the internal participant does not answer
or the line is busy, press the display key
§End§ to return to the external call.
When transferring a call you can also press
the end call key before the internal
participant answers.
Then, if the internal participant does not
answer or the line is busy, the call will
automatically return to you (the display
will show Recall).
Initiating internal consultation call,
conference call
You are talking to an external participant
(via fixed line network or VoIP) and can
call an internal participant at the same
time to hold a consultation call.
Open the list of handsets.
The external participant hears
hold music if activated
(page 97).
Select handset and press §OK§.
When an internal participant answers you
can speak to them.
You have the following options:
Ending a consultation call
§End§
Press the display key.
You are reconnected with the external
participant.
Initiating a conference call
Version 4, 16.09.2005
§Conf.§
Press the display key.
You are in a three-way conference call
with the external participant and the internal participant.
If the internal participant who has been
called ends the call (press end call key
), you will be connected with the
external participant. If you press end call
key , the external call will be transferred to the internal participant.
84
Accepting/rejecting call waiting during
an internal call
If you receive an external call during an
internal call, you will hear the call waiting
tone (short tone). With Calling Line Identification, the caller's number will appear in
the display.
Ending an internal call, accepting an
external call
§Accept§
Press the display key.
The internal call is ended. You are connected to the external caller.
Rejecting the external call
§Reject§
Press the display key.
The call waiting tone is turned off.
You remain connected with the internal
participant. The ringer tone can still be
heard on other registered handsets.
Using a handset as a
room monitor
If the room monitor is activated, a previously stored destination number is called
as soon as a set noise level is reached in
the room.
You can save an internal or external
number in your handset as the destination
number.
The room monitor call to an external
number stops after around 90 seconds.
The room monitor call to an internal
number (handset) stops after approx. 3
minutes (depending on the base station).
During use as a room monitor, all keys are
barred except for the end call key . The
speaker of the handset is muted.
When the room monitor is activated,
incoming calls to the handset are indicated without a ringer tone and are only
shown on the screen. The display and keypad are not illuminated and advisory
tones are also turned off.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / T-NetBox_SAG-registration.fm / 27.10.08
Using several handsets
If you accept an incoming call, the room
monitor is suspended for the duration of
the call, but the function remains activated.
If you deactivate then re-activate the
handset, the room monitor remains activated.
Warning!
– You should always check the operation
of the room monitor before use. For
example, test its sensitivity. Check the
connection if you are diverting the room
monitor to an outside number.
– When the function is switched on, the
handset's operating time is considerably
reduced. If necessary, place the handset in
the charging cradle. This ensures that the
batteries do not run down.
– Ideally the handset should be positioned 1
to 2 metres away from the baby. The microphone must be directed towards the baby.
– The connection to which the room monitor
is forwarded must not be blocked by an
activated answer machine.
Activating the room monitor and
entering the number to be called
Version 4, 16.09.2005
v ¢ ¢ Room Monitor
¤ Change multiple line input:
Room M.:
Select On to activate.
Call to:
External number:
¤ Select the number from the directory (press display key ) or
enter it directly. Only the last 4
characters are displayed.
Internal number:
¤ Press the display key §Options§.
Select INT and press §OK§.
¤ Use to select the handset or Call
All (if all registered handsets are to
be called) and press §OK§.
Level:
Set noise level sensitivity (Low or High).
¤ Save changes (page 147).
The function is now activated.
You can use the §Options§ display key to
switch directly to the baby alarm settings.
Please note:
If you do not specify a line suffix (page 27) and
you do not define any dialling plans for the
number (page 124), an external number will
be dialled via the set standard connection
(VoIP or fixed line network).
Changing the set destination number
v ¢ ¢ Room Monitor
Scroll to the Call to: line.
X or §Delete§
Delete existing number.
¤ Enter number as described in "Activating the room monitor and entering the
number to be called" (page 85).
Deactivating the room monitor
remotely
Precondition: The room monitor call is
sent to an external destination number.
The telephone called supports touch tone
dialling.
¤ Accept the call from the room monitor
and press keys 9 ;.
Your base station sends a confirmation
tone and ends the connection.
Please note:
External deactivating via VoIP connections is
possible as long as the DTMF signals are transmitted (depending on the provider) either as
SIP info messages, audible signals in the voice
channel (inband or audio) or as special RTP
data packets (pursuant to RFC2833).
The room monitor function is deactivated
on the handset. There will be no further
room monitor calls. The other room monitor settings (e.g. no ringer tone) on the
handset will remain activated until you
press the display key §OFF§ on the handset.
To re-activate the room function with the
same phone number:
¤ Turn on the activation again and save
with §Save§ (page 85).
85
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / settings_bs_hs_pabx.fm / 27.10.08
Handset settings
Handset settings
Your handset is preconfigured, but you
can change the settings to suit your individual requirements.
Changing the display language
You can view the display texts in different
languages.
v ¢ ¢ Handset ¢ Language
The current language is indicated by ‰ .
Select a language and press
§OK§.
Press and hold (idle status).
If you accidentally choose a language you
do not understand:
v N Press keys in sequence.
Select the correct language
and press §OK§.
Setting the display
Version 4, 16.09.2005
You have a choice of four colour schemes
and several different contrasts.
v ¢ ¢ Display
Colour Scheme
Select and press §OK§.
Select a colour scheme and
press §OK§ ( ‰ = current colour).
Press briefly.
Scroll to the Contrast line.
Contrast
Select and press §OK§.
Select contrast.
§Save§
Press the display key.
Press and hold (idle status).
86
Setting the screensaver
You can set a picture from the Resource
Dir. (page 90) to be displayed as a screensaver when the handset is in idle status.
This will replace the idle status display. It
may conceal the date, time and name.
The screensaver is not displayed in certain
situations, e.g. during a call or if the handset is de-registered.
If a screensaver is activated, the Screen
Saver menu option is marked with ‰ .
v ¢ ¢ Display ¢ Screen Saver
The current setting is displayed.
¤ Change multiple line input:
Activation:
Select On (screensaver is displayed) or
Off (no screensaver).
Selection:
If required, change the screensaver
(see below).
¤ Save changes: (page 147).
If the screensaver conceals the display,
briefly press to show the idle display
with time and date.
Changing the screensaver
v ¢ ¢ Display ¢ Screen Saver
Scroll to the Selection line.
§View§
Press the display key. The
active screensaver is displayed.
Select screensaver and press
§Change§.
¤ Save changes: (page 147).
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / settings_bs_hs_pabx.fm / 27.10.08
Handset settings
Setting the display backlight
Depending on whether or not the handset
is in the charging cradle you can set different levels of display illumination. If it is
activated, the display is permanently
dimmed.
v ¢ ¢ Display ¢ Backlight
The current setting is displayed.
¤ Change multiple line input:
In Charger
Select On or Off.
Without Charger
Select On or Off.
§Save§
Press the display key.
Press and hold (idle status).
Please note:
The handset's standby time can be significantly reduced if the display backlight (On) is
activated.
The following features are available:
Quick Dial / Call-by-Call
Assign key to a number from the directory or call-by-call list.
The directory or call-by-call list is
opened.
¤ Select an entry and press §OK§.
If you delete or edit an entry in the
directory or call-by-call list, this has no
effect on the assignment to the digit/
display key.
Please note:
A number from the directory with a hash
(#) at the end will be dialled via the standard connection, otherwise it is always
dialled via the non-standard connection
(page 98).
u INT (§INT§)
Opens the list of internal participants.
u SMS (§SMS§)
Shortcuts for functions and
numbers
You can assign the left display key and
each of the digit keys Q and to
O a number or a function. The right display key has a function pre-selected by
default. You can change the function
assigned.
The number is then dialled or the function
started by simply pressing a key.
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Assigning a digit key/left display key
Precondition: The digit key or the left display key has not yet been assigned a
number or a function.
¤ Press the display key or press
and hold the digit key.
The list of possible key assignments is
opened (see below).
¤ Select the function with the control key
and press §OK§. The handset returns
to idle status.
u
u
u
u
Opens the SMS submenu for writing,
sending and reading SMS messages
(page 54):
¢ SMS
Room Monitor (§Room M.§)
Assign menu for setting and activating
the room monitor to a key (page 85).
Alarm Clock (§Alarm§)
Assign menu for setting and activating
the alarm clock to a key (page 91).
Calendar (§Calendar§)
Opens the calendar to enter new or
view saved appointments: Withhold No. (§Withhold§)
If you press the display key §Withhold§,
your phone number will not be transmitted for the next call and will therefore not appear in the recipient's display.
If you press the display key §Withhold§,
a number editor will be opened.
Enter the phone number and press the
display key §Send§.
87
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / settings_bs_hs_pabx.fm / 27.10.08
Handset settings
u
u
u
u
u
The number is always dialled via the
fixed line network. This function does
not support dialling with a line suffix.
Bluetooth (§Bluetooth§)
Assign the Bluetooth menu to a key:
v ¢ ¢ Data Transfer ¢ Bluetooth
E-mail (§EMail§)
Opens the e-mail submenu for receiving and reading e-mail notifications
(page 68):
¢ E-mail
Messenger (§Messgr.§)
Opens the Messenger submenu for
chatting with friends on the Internet
(page 71):
¢ Messenger
Fixed Line Call (§FixedLine§)
Opens the pre-dialling option for making a call via the fixed line network.
IP Call (§IP§)
Opens the pre-dialling option for making a call via VoIP.
If the display keys have been assigned a
shortcut, the selected function or name of
the phone number in the directory or callby-call list is displayed (abbreviated if necessary) in the bottom display line via the
relevant display key.
Starting the function, dialling the
number
If the handset is in idle status, press and
hold the digit key or press the display key
briefly.
Depending on the key assignment:
u Numbers are dialled directly.
u The function menu is opened.
Changing key assignments
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Display key
¤ Press and hold the left or right display
key.
88
The list of possible key assignments is
opened.
¤ Proceed as is described when first
assigning the key with a shortcut
(page 87).
Digit key
¤ Press the digit key briefly.
Press the display key. The list
of possible key assignments is
displayed.
Proceed as is described when first
assigning the key with a shortcut
(page 87).
§Change§
¤
Activating/deactivating
auto answer
If you activate this function, when you
receive a call you can simply lift the handset out of the charging cradle without having to press the talk key .
v ¢ ¢ Handset
Auto Answer
Select and press §OK§ ( ‰ = on).
Press and hold (idle status).
Changing the handsfree/
earpiece volume
You can set the loudspeaker volume for
handsfree talking to five different levels
and the earpiece volume to three different
levels.
In the handset idle status:
Press the control key at the
top.
Handset Volume
Select and press §OK§.
Set the earpiece volume.
Scroll to the Handsfree Volume
line.
Set the handsfree volume.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / settings_bs_hs_pabx.fm / 27.10.08
Handset settings
Press display key if necessary
to save the setting permanently.
Setting the volume during a call:
Press the control key.
Select volume.
§Save§
Press display key if necessary
to save the setting permanently.
The setting is automatically saved after
approx. 3 seconds.
If is assigned with another function,
e.g. toggling (page 38):
§Options§
Open menu.
Volume
Select and press §OK§.
Configure setting (see above).
§Save§
Please note:
You can also adjust the call volume via the
Audio Settings
Handset Volume .
menu £
£
Changing ringer tones
u Volume:
Version 4, 16.09.2005
You can choose between five volumes
(1–5; e.g. volume 2 = -) and
the "crescendo" ring (6; volume
increases with each ring =
.).
u Ringer tones:
You can select various ringer tones,
melodies or any sound from My stuff
(page 90).
You can set different ringer tones for the
following functions:
u Ext. Calls: for external calls
u Internal Calls: for internal calls
u Appointments: for set appointments
(page 92)
u All: the same ringer tone for all functions
Settings for individual functions
Set the volume and melody depending on
the type of signalling required.
In the handset idle status:
Press the control key at the
top.
Ringer Settings
Select and press §OK§.
Ext. Calls / Internal Calls / Appointments
Select and press §OK§.
¤ Change multiple line input:
Set volume (1–6).
Scroll to the next line.
Select melody.
§Save§
Press the display key to save
the setting.
Same ringer tone for all functions
In the handset idle status:
¢ Ringer Settings ¢ All
¤ Set volume and ringer tone (see
"Settings for individual functions").
§Save§
Press the display key to confirm the prompt.
Press and hold (idle status).
Please note:
You can also adjust the ringer tones via the
menu Audio Settings
Ringer Settings.
£
£
Activating/deactivating the ringer tone
You can deactivate the ringer tone on your
handset before you answer a call or when
the handset is in idle status; the ringer
tone can be deactivated permanently or
just for the current call. The ringer tone
cannot be re-activated while an external
call is in progress.
Deactivating the ringer tone permanently
Press and hold the star key.
The Ú icon appears in the display.
89
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / settings_bs_hs_pabx.fm / 27.10.08
Handset settings
Re-activating the ringer tone
Press and hold the star key.
Deactivating the ringer tone for the current
call
§Silence§
Press the display key.
Activating/deactivating the alert tone
In place of the ringer tone you can activate
an alert tone. When you receive a call, you
will hear a short tone ("Beep") instead of
the ringer tone.
Press and hold the star key
and within 3 seconds:
§Beep§
Press the display key. A call will
now be signalled by one short
alert tone. / appears in the
display.
Activating/deactivating
advisory tones
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Your handset uses "advisory tones" to tell
you about different activities and statuses.
The following advisory tones can be activated/deactivated independently of each
other:
u Key click: every key press is confirmed.
u Advisory Tones:
– Confirmation tone (ascending tone
sequence): at the end of an entry/
setting and when an SMS or a new
entry arrives in the calls list or in the
answer machine list
– Error tone (descending tone
sequence): when you make an
incorrect entry
– Menu end tone: when scrolling at
the end of a menu
u Battery tone: the batteries need to be
charged.
90
In the handset idle status:
Press the control key at the
top.
Advisory Tones
Select and press §OK§.
¤ Change multiple line input:
Key Tones:
Select On or Off.
Confirm.:
Select On or Off.
Battery:
Select On, Off or In Call. The battery
warning tone is only activated/deactivated and only sounds during a call.
¤ Save changes (page 147).
You cannot deactivate the confirmation
tone for placing the handset in the charging cradle.
Please note:
You can also adjust the ringer tones via the
menu Audio Settings
Advisory Tones .
£
£
My stuff
My stuff on the handset manages sounds,
which you can use as ringer tones, and
pictures (CLIP pictures and screensavers),
which you can use as caller pictures or as
screensavers. Precondition: Calling Line
Identification (CLIP).
My stuff can manage the following media
types:
Icon
Sound
Format
1
Ringer tones
Standard
Monophonic
Standard
2
Polyphonic
.mid
Picture:
CLIP picture
BMP
128 x 100 px
Or
128 x 160 px
(px = Pixel)
Screensaver
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / settings_bs_hs_pabx.fm / 27.10.08
Handset settings
The icon is displayed in front of the name
in My stuff. Various mono- and polyphonic
sounds and pictures are preconfigured on
your handset.
You can listen to the available sounds and
view the pictures. You can download your
own pictures from a PC to the
Gigaset S68H handset using Bluetooth
connections and save them in My stuff
(page 149).
The pre-configured pictures are labelled
with 4. You cannot rename or delete
them.
Playing back sounds/viewing CLIP
pictures
v ¢ ¢ Screensavers / Caller Pictures
/ Sounds (select entry)
§Play§ / View Press the display key. Sounds
are played back or pictures are
displayed. Press the key to
switch between entries.
§End§ / Press the display key. Playback
of the sound or display of the
picture ends.
While you are playing back
sounds, you can also interrupt
playback with the key.
Press and hold (idle status).
If you have saved a picture in an invalid
data format, you will see an error message
after selecting the entry. Cancel the operation with Î. Delete the picture
with §Delete§.
Sounds: Setting the volume
Version 4, 16.09.2005
During playback:
§Volume§
Press the display key.
Set volume.
§Save§
Press the display key.
Renaming/deleting a picture
You have selected an entry.
§Options
Open menu.
If a picture cannot be deleted (4), these
options are not available. Depending on
the situation, you can select the following
functions:
Delete Entry
The selected entry is deleted.
Delete List
All entries in the list that can be deleted
are deleted.
Rename
Change the name (max. 16 characters)
and press §Save§. The entry is stored with
the new name.
Gigaset S68H:
Checking the memory
You can check how much memory is available for screensavers and CLIP pictures.
v ¢ ¢ Capacity
Back: Press the display key.
Setting the alarm clock
Precondition: The date and time have
already been set (page 11).
Activating/deactivating the alarm
clock and setting the wake-up time
v¢
¤ Change multiple line input:
Activation:
Select On or Off.
Time:
Enter the wake-up time in 4-digit format.
Occurance:
Select Daily or Monday-Friday.
Volume:
Set loudspeaker (1–6).
91
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / settings_bs_hs_pabx.fm / 27.10.08
Handset settings
Melody:
Select melody.
¤ Save changes (page 147).
You will see the icon.
A wake-up call with the selected ringer
tone is signalled on the handset. The
wake-up call sounds for 60 seconds. is
shown in the display. If no key is pressed,
the wake-up call is repeated twice at five
minute intervals and then turned off.
During a call, the wake-up call is signalled
by a short tone.
Deactivating the wake-up call/
repeating after a pause (snooze mode)
Precondition: A wake-up call is sounding.
§OFF§
Press the display key. The
wake-up call is deactivated.
Or
§Snooze§
Press the display key or any
key. The wake-up call is deactivated and then repeated after
5 minutes. After the second
repetition the wake-up call is
deactivated completely.
Setting an appointment
(calendar)
You can have your handset remind you of
up to 30 appointments (volume and melody, see page 89).
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Saving an appointment
If you have already saved 30 appointments, you must first delete an existing
appointment.
Precondition: The date and time have
already been set (page 11).
v ¢ Open the graphical calendar.
Days on which appointments
have already been saved are
highlighted in black.
/
Select day and press §OK§.
92
If appointments have already been saved
for the day, the list of appointments will
be displayed: select <New Entry> and press
§OK§.
¤ Change multiple line input:
Appoint.:
Select On or Off.
Date:
Enter day/month/year in 8-digit format.
Time:
Enter hours/minutes in 4-digit format.
Notes:
Enter text (max. of 16 characters). The
text appears as the appointment name
in the list and will be displayed on the
screen during the appointment
reminder. If you do not enter any text,
only the date and time of the appointment are displayed.
§Save§
Press the display key.
Press and hold (idle status).
The appointment is marked with ‰ in the
appointments list. The list of appointments is sorted by date.
An appointment reminder is signalled
with the selected ringer tone (page 89).
The appointment reminder sounds for
60 seconds. The entered text, date and
time are displayed.
During a call, the appointment reminder is
signalled by a short tone.
Managing appointments
v¢
/
Select the day in the graphical
calendar and press §OK§ or v.
Days on which appointments
have already been saved are
highlighted in black in the calendar.
Select appointment for the
day.
§Options§
Open menu
Back with §.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / settings_bs_hs_pabx.fm / 27.10.08
Handset settings
You have the following options:
View Entry
View selected appointment.
Open the §Options§ menu for editing,
deleting and activating/deactivating.
Edit Entry
Edit selected appointment.
Delete Entry
Delete selected appointment.
Activate / Deactivate
Activate/deactivate the selected
appointment.
Delete List
Delete all appointments.
Deactivating or accepting an
appointment reminder
Precondition: An appointment reminder
is sounding.
¤ Press the display key §OFF§ to switch off
the appointment reminder.
Or:
¤ Press the display key §SMS§ to write an
SMS.
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Displaying missed
appointments
and anniversaries
Missed appointments/anniversaries
(page 45) are displayed in the Missed
Alarms list if:
u You do not accept an appointment/
anniversary.
u The appointment/anniversary was signalled during a phone call.
u The handset is deactivated at the time
of the appointment/anniversary.
u Automatic redial was activated at the
time of an appointment/anniversary
(page 48).
The most recent entry is at the head of the
list.
If there is a new appointment/anniversary
in the list, the display shows §Appoint.§.
Pressing the display key will also open the
Missed Alarms list.
To open the list from the menu:
v ¢ ¢ Missed Alarms
Select appointment/anniversary.
Information about the
appointment/anniversary is
displayed. A missed appointment is displayed with the
appointment name and a
missed anniversary is displayed with the last name and
first name. The date and time
will also be given.
§Delete§
Delete appointment.
§SMS§
Write an SMS
Press and hold (idle status).
If 10 entries are already stored in the list,
the next appointment reminder will delete
the oldest entry.
Gigaset S68H handset:
using Bluetooth devices
Your Gigaset S68H handset can communicate wirelessly via Bluetooth™ with other
devices using this technology.
Before you can use your Bluetooth
devices, you must first activate Bluetooth
and then register the devices to the handset.
You can register 1 Bluetooth headset to
the handset. You can also register up to 5
data devices (PC, PDA) to send and receive
directory entries as vCards or exchange
data with the computer (page 147).
In order to transfer phone numbers via
Bluetooth, it is essential that area codes
(international and local area codes) are
saved on the phone (see page 95).
You will find a description of how to operate your Bluetooth devices in the user
guides for these devices.
93
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / settings_bs_hs_pabx.fm / 27.10.08
Handset settings
Trust Device Select and press §OK§.
Please note:
– You can only operate headsets on your
handset that have the headset profile.
– It can take up to 5 seconds to create a connection between your handset and a Bluetooth headset. This applies both when a call
is accepted using the headset or transferred
to the headset, and when a number is
dialled from the headset.
Activating/deactivating Bluetooth
mode
v ¢ ¢ Data Transfer ¢ Bluetooth
¢ Activation
Press §OK§ to activate or deactivate Bluetooth mode ( ‰ = activated).
In idle status, the icon on the handset
shows that Bluetooth mode is activated:
Ð
V
INT 1
Registering Bluetooth devices
The distance between the handset in Bluetooth mode and the activated Bluetooth
device (headset or data device) should be
no more than 10 m.
Please note:
Version 4, 16.09.2005
– If you register a headset, any headset that is
already registered will be overwritten.
– If you register a headset to your handset
that is already registered to another device
(e.g. to a mobile phone), the existing registration data may be overwritten by the new
registration.
If you would like to operate a headset on
both the mobile phone and on your handset, you should use a headset that supports
several terminals.
v ¢ ¢ Data Transfer ¢ Bluetooth
¢ Search Headset / Search Data Device
The search can take up to 30 seconds.
Once the device has been found, its name
will be shown on the display.
§Options§
Press the display key.
94
Enter the PIN for the Bluetooth
device you want to register
and press §OK§.
The device is saved in the list of known
devices.
Cancelling/repeating current search
To cancel search:
§Cancel§
Press the display key.
Repeat search if necessary:
§Options§
Select and press §OK§.
Repeat Search
Select and press §OK§.
Editing the list of known (trusted)
devices
Open list
v ¢ ¢ Data Transfer ¢ Bluetooth
¢ Known Devices
A corresponding icon appears next to each
device name in the list displayed:
Icon
Meaning
5
Bluetooth headset
6
Bluetooth data device
Viewing entries
Open list ¢ (select entry)
§Options§
Press the display key.
View Entry Select and press §OK§.
Device name and address are
displayed.
Back with §OK§.
De-registering Bluetooth devices
Open list ¢ (select entry)
§Options§
Press the display key.
Delete Entry Select and press §OK§.
Back: Press and hold key.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / settings_bs_hs_pabx.fm / 27.10.08
Handset settings
Please note:
If you are using a headset and you complete
the registration process by entering the PIN,
the headset is saved in the device list as a data
device and not as a headset. Therefore, initiate
a new registration by searching for a headset.
Changing the name of a Bluetooth device
Open list ¢ (select entry)
§Options§
Press the display key.
Rename
Select and press §OK§.
Change the name.
§Save§
Press the display key
Back: Press and hold key.
Rejecting/accepting an unregistered
Bluetooth device
If a Bluetooth device that is not registered
in the list of known devices tries to connect with the handset, you will be
prompted on the display to enter the PIN
for the Bluetooth device (bonding).
u Reject
§Go Back§
Press the display key.
u Accept
Enter the PIN for the Bluetooth
device you want to accept and
press §OK§.
If you have accepted the device, you
can use it temporarily (i.e. as long as it
is within receiving range or until you
deactivate the handset) or save it to the
list of known devices.
Once the PIN has been confirmed, save
to the list of known devices:
– §Yes§ Press the display key.
– §No§ Press the display key:
use temporarily.
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Changing the Bluetooth name of the
handset
You can change the name of your handset
used to identify it on the display of other
Bluetooth devices.
v ¢ ¢ Data Transfer ¢ Bluetooth
¢ Own Device Name
Press the display key
Change the name.
Press the display key
Back: Press and hold key.
§Change§
§Save§
Setting your own area code
In order to transfer phone numbers via
Bluetooth connections to the phone
(Gigaset S68H handset) and to correctly
manage entries in your directory, it is
essential that your area code (international and local area code) is saved on the
phone.
If necessary these numbers are already
preset.
v ¢ ¢ Handset ¢ Area Codes
Check that the (pre)set area code is correct.
¤ Change multiple line input:
Select/change input field.
Navigate in the input field.
X
Delete number if necessary:
Press the display key.
Enter number.
Press the display key.
§Save§
Example:
Area Codes
International code:
00
- 44
Local area code:
0
- [ 20
]
X
Save
Please note:
For how to enter your own area code using the
Web configurator, see page 123.
95
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / settings_bs_hs_pabx.fm / 27.10.08
Base station settings
Restoring the handset to the
factory settings
Each individual handset setting is reset, in
particular the language, display, volume,
ringer and alarm clock settings (see from
page 86 onwards). The last number redial
list is cleared.
Entries in the directory, the call-by-call list,
the call history, the SMS lists and the
handset's registration to the base station
as well as the content of My stuff are
retained.
v ¢ ¢ Handset ¢ Reset Handset
§Yes§
Press the display key.
You can cancel the factory
reset by pressing or the
display key §No§.
Press and hold (idle status).
Base station settings
The base station settings are carried out
using a registered Gigaset S67H/S68H
handset.
Protecting against unauthorised
access
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Protect the system settings of the base station with a PIN known only to yourself.
You have to enter the system PIN if,
among other things, you register and deregister a handset, change VoIP settings or
reset the phone to factory settings.
96
Changing the system PIN
You have to enter the system pin when,
for example, you register a handset with
the base station, change VoIP settings or
start the Web configurator.
You can change the base station's 4-digit
default system PIN ("0000") to a 4-digit
system PIN known only to yourself.
v ¢ ¢ Base ¢ System PIN
Enter the current system PIN
and press §OK§.
Enter new system PIN.
Scroll to the Re-enter PIN: line.
Now re-enter the new system
PIN and press §OK§.
For security reasons, "****" is displayed
instead of the system PIN.
Press and hold (idle status).
Restoring the base station to the
factory settings
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / settings_bs_hs_pabx.fm / 27.10.08
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Base station settings
Resetting the base station via the
menu
Resetting the base station using a key
on the base station
Each individual setting is reset, in particular:
u VoIP settings such as VoIP provider and
account data and DTMF settings
(page 99, page 110, page 122)
u Settings for the local network
(page 101, page 109)
u Default connection (page 98)
u The names of the handsets (page 83)
u SMS settings (e.g. SMS centres,
page 53)
u Settings for the connection to the PABX
(page 102)
u On the Gigaset S675/S685 IP:
The answer machine settings (page 65)
and own announcements are deleted
As with resetting the base station via the
menu, all individual settings are reset. The
system PIN will also be reset to "0000"
and all handsets registered above and
beyond the scope of delivery will be deregistered.
The following lists are deleted:
u SMS lists
u Calls list
u On the Gigaset S675/S685 IP:
Answer machine lists
The following are not reset:
u Date and time
u System PIN
The handsets are still registered.
v ¢ ¢ Base ¢ Base Reset
Enter the system PIN and press
§OK§.
§Yes§
Press the display key to
confirm.
¤
Please note:
For how to re-register the handsets after resetting, if necessary, see page 81.
¤ Remove the cable connections from
¤
¤
¤
¤
the base station to the router (page 15)
and fixed line network (page 14).
Remove the base station mains adapter
from the socket (page 14).
Press and hold the registration/paging
key (page 2).
Plug the mains adapter back into the
power socket.
Continue to press and hold the registration/paging key (at least 2 sec.).
Release the registration/paging key.
The base station has now been reset.
Activating/deactivating
music on hold
v ¢ ¢ Base
Music on hold
Select and press §OK§ to activate
or deactivate music on hold
( ‰ = on).
97
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / settings_bs_hs_pabx.fm / 27.10.08
Base station settings
Activating/deactivating
repeater mode
Updating the base station
firmware
With a repeater you can increase the range
and reception strength of your base station. You will need to activate repeater
mode. This will terminate any calls being
made via the base station at that time.
Preconditions:
u A repeater is registered with the base
station.
¤ Eco mode is deactivated (page 20).
v ¢ ¢ Base ¢ Add. Features
Repeater Mode
Select and press §OK§ ( ‰ = on).
§Yes§
Press the display key to confirm the security prompt.
If necessary, you can update your base station firmware.
The firmware update is downloaded
directly from the Internet by default. The
relevant Web page is preconfigured in
your phone.
Set default connection
Starting the firmware update manually
You can make settings according to
whether you want to make calls via VoIP or
the fixed line network by default.
Please note:
– The standard connection is only relevant
when dialling numbers that are not subject
to dialling plans (page 124) and are
entered without a line suffix (page 27).
– For how to set the default connection using
the Web configurator, see page 119.
v ¢ ¢ Telephony ¢ Default Line
VoIP / Fixed Line
Select and press §OK§ ( ‰ = on).
When making calls:
¤ Press the talk key briefly if you
Version 4, 16.09.2005
¤
98
want to make the call via the default
connection.
Press and hold the talk key if you
want to make the call via the other connection type.
Precondition:
The base station is in idle status, i.e.:
u No calls are being made via the fixed
line network or VoIP.
u There is no internal connection
between the registered handsets.
u No other handset has opened the base
station menu.
v ¢ ¢ Base
Software Update
Select and press §OK§.
Enter the system PIN and press
§OK§.
The base station establishes a connection
to the Internet or to the local PC.
§Yes§
Press the display key to start
the firmware update.
Please note:
– The firmware update can last up to 3 minutes.
– When updating from the Internet, checks
are made to ensure that no newer version
of the firmware exists. If this is not the case,
the operation is terminated and a message
is issued to that effect.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / settings_bs_hs_pabx.fm / 27.10.08
Making VoIP settings
Automatic firmware update
Your phone will check daily whether a
newer firmware update is available via the
Internet on the Gigaset configuration
server. If this is the case, the message New
firmware available is displayed when the
handset is in idle status and the message
key flashes.
Press the message key.
§Yes§
Press the display key to confirm the prompt.
The firmware will be loaded onto your
phone.
Please note:
– If you reply to the prompt with §No§, the display will not be repeated.The message New
firmware available will only be shown again if
a newer version of the firmware than the
one rejected is available.
– You can deactivate the automatic version
check via the Web configurator (page 133).
Making VoIP settings
In order to be able to use VoIP, you must
set a few parameters for your phone.
You can make the following settings using
your handset.
u Download the general access data for
your VoIP provider from the Gigaset
configuration server and store them on
your phone.
u Enter your personal access data for
your first VoIP account (first VoIP phone
number). You can configure the access
data for five further VoIP accounts via
the phone's Web configurator.
u Set the phone's IP address in the LAN.
Please note:
You can set these and other parameters conveniently via the Web configurator on a PC
connected to your local network (see
page 110).
The connection assistant on your phone
can help you make the settings.
Using the connection assistant
Version 4, 16.09.2005
The connection assistant starts automatically when you set the handset and base
station up for the first time, or when you
try to connect to the Internet before making the necessary settings.
You can also start the connection assistant
via the menu:
v ¢ ¢ Telephony
Connection Assist.
Select and press §OK§.
Enter the system PIN and press
§OK§.
For how to enter VoIP settings using the
connection assistant, see page 16.
99
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / settings_bs_hs_pabx.fm / 27.10.08
Making VoIP settings
Changing settings without the
connection assistant
You can change your provider's VoIP settings and the VoIP user data via the menu
without starting the connection assistant.
Downloading your VoIP provider's
settings
The general settings for various VoIP providers are available for download on the
Internet. The relevant Web page is preconfigured in your phone.
Precondition: Your phone is connected to
the Internet.
v ¢ ¢ Telephony ¢ VoIP
Enter the system PIN and press
§OK§.
Select Provider
Select and press §OK§.
The phone establishes a connection to the
Internet.
Select country and press §OK§.
Select your VoIP provider and
press §OK§.
Your VoIP provider data is downloaded
and saved in your phone.
Please note:
Version 4, 16.09.2005
– If an error occurs during the download, an
error message will be displayed. You can
find possible messages and measures in the
table on page 136.
– You can make and adapt the general settings for your VoIP provider manually via
your phone's Web configurator, see
page 111.
100
Automatic update for the VoIP provider
settings
After the first download of the VoIP
provider settings, your phone will check
daily whether a newer version of the file
for your VoIP provider is available via the
Internet on the Gigaset configuration
server. If this is the case, the message New
profile available will be displayed when the
handset is in idle status, and the message
key flashes.
Press the message key.
§Yes§
Press the display key to confirm the prompt.
Enter the system PIN and press
§OK§.
The new data for your VoIP provider will be
downloaded and saved on the phone.
Please note:
– If you reply to the prompt with §No§, the display will not be repeated. The message New
profile available will only be shown again if a
newer version of the VoIP settings than the
one rejected is available.
– You can deactivate the automatic version
check via the Web configurator (page 133).
Entering/changing VoIP user data
The VoIP settings must also be extended
for your personal data. You will receive all
necessary data from your VoIP provider.
Please note:
When making these entries, please remember
the VoIP user data is case sensitive. To enter
text see page 147.
v ¢ ¢ Telephony ¢ VoIP (Enter
system PIN) ¢ Provider Registr.
¤ Change multiple line input:
Username:
Enter the user name (caller ID) for your
VoIP provider account. Username is
often identical to your Internet telephone number (the first part of your
SIP address, see page 113).
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / settings_bs_hs_pabx.fm / 27.10.08
Making VoIP settings
Authent. Name: / Authent. Password:
Enter the provider-dependent access
data that has to be transferred by the
phone to the SIP service at registration.
¤ Click §Save§ to save the settings.
Setting the phone's IP address in
the LAN
The base station requires an IP address in
order to be "recognised" by the LAN.
The IP address can be assigned to the base
station automatically (by the router) or
manually.
u If performed dynamically, the router's
DHCP server automatically assigns the
base station an IP address. The base
station's IP address can be changed
according to router settings.
u If performed manually/statically, you
assign the base station a static IP
address. This may be necessary
depending on your network configuration.
Please note:
– For how to make the local network settings
on the Web configurator, turn to page 109.
– To assign the IP address dynamically, the
DHCP server on the router must be activated. Please also read the user guide for
your router.
Version 4, 16.09.2005
v ¢ ¢ Base ¢ Local Network
Enter the system PIN and press
§OK§.
¤ Change multiple line input:
IP Address Type:
Select Static or Dynamic.
If you select Static, you must manually
define the IP address and the subnet
mask for the base station in the next
lines, as well as the standard gateway
and DNS server.
IP Address:
For IP Address Type = Dynamic:
The IP address that is currently assigned
to the base station will be displayed. It
cannot be amended.
For IP Address Type = Static:
Enter the IP address that is to be
assigned to the base station (overwriting the current settings).
192.168.2.2 has been preset.
For the IP address see also page 165.
Subnet Mask:
For IP Address Type = Dynamic:
The subnet mask that is currently
assigned to the base station will be displayed. It cannot be amended.
For IP Address Type = Static:
Enter the subnet mask to be assigned
to the base station (overwriting the
current settings).
The default setting is 255.255.255.0
For the subnet mask see also page 168.
DNS Server:
For IP Address Type = Static:
Enter the IP address for the preferred
DNS server. The DNS server (Domain
Name System) converts the symbolic
name of a server (DNS name) into the
public IP address for the server when
the connection is made.
You can specify your router's IP address
here. The router forwards phone
address requests to its DNS server.
192.168.2.1 has been preset.
Default Gateway:
For IP Address Type = Static:
Enter the IP address for the standard
gateway, by means of which the local
network is connected with the Internet.
This is generally the local (private) IP
address for your router (e.g.
192.168.2.1). Your phone requires this
information to be able to access the
Internet.
192.168.2.1 has been preset.
¤ Click §Save§ to save the settings.
101
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / settings_bs_hs_pabx.fm / 27.10.08
Operating the base station on the PABX
Please note:
You can find notes on the IP address and the
subnet mask on page 109 and in the glossary
on page 165/page 168.
Activating/deactivating display
of VoIP status messages
If the function is activated, a VoIP status
code for your service provider is displayed.
Activate the function if, for example, you
have problems with VoIP connections. You
will receive a provider-specific status
code, which supports the service when
the problem is analysed. You will find a
table with the possible status screens in
the appendix (page 140).
v ¢ ¢ Telephony ¢ VoIP
Enter the system PIN and press
§OK§.
Show Stat. on HS
Select and press §OK§ ( ‰ = on).
Please note:
For how to make the setting on the Web configurator, see page 135.
Checking the base station
MAC address
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Depending on your network configuration, you may have to enter your base station MAC address, for example, into your
router's access control list. You can check
your base station MAC address:
vNOQ
The base station MAC address is displayed.
Press and hold (idle status).
102
Operating the base station
on the PABX
The following settings are only necessary
when your PABX requires them; see the
PABX user guide. The settings only concern fixed line network connections.
You cannot send or receive SMS messages
on PABXs that do not support Calling Line
Identification.
Changing the dialling mode
You can set the dialling mode.
v ¢ ¢ Telephony ¢ Fixed Line
¢ Dialling Mode
Tone / Pulse
Select and press §OK§ ( ‰ = on).
Press and hold (idle status).
Please note:
– Suffix dialling (to select the connection) is
not possible in pulse dialling mode:
A hash "#" is displayed when dialling, but is
ignored when pulse dialling.
– Enter an asterisk "*" to switch temporarily to
tone dialling. The asterisk is not displayed.
Setting recall
You can set the recall option.
v ¢ ¢ Telephony ¢ Fixed Line
¢ Recall
Select recall and press §OK§.
The current setting is indicated by ‰ .
Press and hold (idle status).
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / settings_bs_hs_pabx.fm / 27.10.08
Operating the base station on the PABX
Setting pauses
Changing pause after line seizure
You can set the length of the pause
inserted between pressing the talk key
and sending the phone number.
vNO
L
Enter a number for the length
of the pause (1 = 1 sec.;
2 = 3 sec.; 3 = 7 sec.) and
press §OK§.
Changing the pause after the recall key
You can change the length of the pause if
your PABX requires this (refer to the user
guide for your PABX).
vNO
Enter a number for the length
of the pause (1 = 1 sec.;
2 = 2 sec.; 3 = 3 sec.;
4 = 6 sec.) and press §OK§.
Switching temporarily to
tone dialling (DTMF)
Version 4, 16.09.2005
If your PABX still operates with dial pulsing
(DP), but you need touch tone dialling for
a connection (e.g. to listen to the network
mailbox for your fixed line network connection) you must switch to touch tone
dialling for the call.
Precondition: You are currently conducting an external call via the fixed line network or you have dialled an external fixed
line network number or an external call is
signalled.
§Options§
Open menu.
Tone Dialing Select and press §OK§.
Touch tone dialling is now activated for
this call only.
103
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / web_server.fm / 27.10.08
Web configurator –configuring phone via PC
Web configurator –
configuring phone via PC
The Web configurator is the Web interface
for your phone. It allows you to make the
settings for your phone's base station via
your PC's Web browser.
Please note:
Depending on your VoIP provider, it is possible
that you will be unable to change individual
settings in the Web configurator.
Preconditions:
u A standard Web browser is installed on
the PC, e.g. Internet Explorer version
6.0 or higher, or Firefox version 1.0.4 or
higher.
u The phone and PC are connected with
each other via a router.
Please note:
– The phone is not blocked while you make
your settings in the Web configurator. You
can also use your phone to make calls or
change base station or handset settings on
your handset at the same time.
– While you are connected to the Web configurator, it is blocked to other users. It cannot
be accessed by more than one user at any
time.
With the Web configurator on your phone
you have the following options:
u Configure your phone access to the
local network (IP address, gateway to
the Internet).
u Configure your phone for VoIP. Assign
up to six VoIP phone numbers to your
telephone.
u Load new firmware onto the phone if
necessary.
u Use internet services: Enable access to
an online directory, display text information on the handset (info services)
and synchronise the telephone's date/
time with a time server on the Internet.
104
u Manage the names and internal num-
bers of registered handsets and your
local directories
u Obtain information about your phone's
status (firmware version, MAC address,
etc.).
Connecting PC with
Web configurator
Precondition: The settings of a firewall
installed on your PC allow the PC and
phone to communicate with each other.
There are two ways of connecting your PC
to the base station Web configurator:
u via the (local) IP address of the base station
u via Gigaset config
Establishing a connection via the IP
address:
¤ Establish the telephone's current IP
address on the handset:
You can see the phone's current IP
address in the handset display by
briefly pressing the paging key on the
base station.
Your phone's IP address can change if
you have activated dynamic IP address
assignment (page 109).
¤ Launch the Web browser on your PC.
¤ Enter http:// and the phone's IP address
into the address field of the Web
browser, e.g. http://192.168.2.2.
¤ Press the return key.
A connection is established to the phone's
Web configurator.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / web_server.fm / 27.10.08
Web configurator –configuring phone via PC
Establish a connection via Gigaset config:
¤ Click OK.
Precondition: The router is connected to
the Internet and your PC can access the
Internet via the router.
Once you have successfully logged in, a
Home screen opens with general information on the Web configurator.
¤ Launch the Web browser on your PC.
¤ Enter the following URL into the Web
Please note:
¤
browser's address field:
http://www.Gigaset-config.com
Press the return key.
You will receive a message stating the
connection will be forwarded to your base
station.
If several Gigaset VoIP phones can be
reached via your Internet connection, you
will be asked to which one of these
phones you would like to be forwarded.
After successfully forwarding the connection, the Login Web page of the Web configurator will be displayed in the Web
browser.
Please note:
The connection between the PC and the Web
configurator is a local connection (LAN connection). The Internet is only accessed to
establish the connection.
Logging in, setting the Web
configurator language
– If you have forgotten your system PIN, you
must restore your device's factory settings.
Please note that this will restore all other
settings too (page 97).
– If you do not make any entries for a lengthy
period (around 10 minutes), you will be
automatically logged off. The next time
you try to make an entry or open a Web
page, the Login Web page will be displayed.
Enter the system PIN again to log in again.
– Any entries that you did not save on the
phone before automatic log-off will be lost.
Logging off
In the menu bar (page 106) at the top
right of every Web page in the Web configurator, you will see the Log Off command.
Click Log Off to log off from the Web configurator.
Warning:
Always use the Log Off command to end the
connection to the Web configurator. If, for
example, you close the Web browser without
logging off beforehand, it is possible that
access to the Web configurator will be blocked
for a few minutes.
Once you have successfully established
the connection, the Login Web page will
be displayed in the Web browser.
You can select the language you want the
menus and Web configurator dialogues to
be displayed in. The language that is currently selected is displayed in the top field
of the Web page.
¤ If necessary, click to open the list of
available languages.
¤ Select the language.
¤ In the bottom field of the Web page,
enter your phone's system PIN (default
setting: 0000) to access the Web configurator functions.
105
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / web_server.fm / 27.10.08
Web configurator –configuring phone via PC
Structure of the Web pages
The Web pages contain the UI elements
displayed in Figure 2.
Navigation area
Working area
Buttons
Menu bar
Figure 2 Example of the structure of a Web page
Menu bar
In the menu bar, the Web configurator
menus are offered in the form of tab
pages.
The following menus are available:
u Home
The start screen is opened once you
have registered with the Web configurator. It contains information on the
Web configurator functions.
u Settings (page 108)
This menu allows you to make settings
on your phone.
106
u Status (page 135)
This menu gives you information about
your phone.
If you click the Settings menu, a list with
this menu's functions is displayed in the
navigation area (see below).
You will find the Log Off function to the
right of the menu bar on every Web page
(page 105).
Please note:
You will find an overview of the Web configurator menu on page 25.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / web_server.fm / 27.10.08
Web configurator –configuring phone via PC
Navigation area
Applying changes
In the navigation area, the functions of the
menu selected in the menu bar
(page 106) are listed.
If you click a function, the associated page
opens in the working area with information and/or fields for your inputs.
If a function is assigned subfunctions,
these are displayed with the function as
soon as you click the function. The relevant page for the first subfunction is displayed in the working area.
As soon as you have made your change on
a page, activate the new setting on the
phone by clicking Set.
If your input in a field does not comply
with the rules for this field, an appropriate
error message will be displayed. You can
then repeat the input.
Working area
Depending on the function selected, information or dialogue boxes are displayed in
the working area, which allow you to
make or change your phone settings.
Making changes
Make settings for entry fields, lists or
options.
u There may be restrictions regarding the
possible values for a field, e.g. entering
special characters or certain value
ranges.
u To open a list, click
. You can choose
between default values.
u There are two kinds of options:
– Options in a list, from which you can
activate one or several options.
Active, i.e. selected options are highlighted with , non-active options
with . You can activate an option
by clicking . The status of the
other options in the list does not
change. You can deactivate an
option by clicking .
– Alternative options. The active
option in the list is highlighted with
, and the non-active with .
You can activate an option by clicking . The previously activated
option is deactivated. You can only
deactivate an option by activating
another option.
Warning:
Changes that have not been saved on your
phone are lost if you move to another Web
page or if the Web configurator is terminated,
e.g. due to the time limit (page 105).
Buttons
Buttons are displayed in the bottom section of the working area.
Set
Save entries on the phone.
Cancel
Reject changes made on the Web page
and reload the settings that are currently saved in your phone to the Web
page.
Opening Web pages
A brief outline of the navigation to the
individual Web configurator functions is
given below.
Example:
Setting DTMF signalling
Settings ¢ Telephony ¢ Advanced Settings
To open the Web page, carry out the following steps after registration:
¤ Click the Settings menu in the menu
bar.
¤ Click the Telephony function in the navigation area.
The subfunctions of Telephony are displayed in the navigation tree.
¤ Click the Advanced Settings subfunction.
The Web page from Figure 2 will be shown
in the Web browser.
107
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / web_server.fm / 27.10.08
Web configurator –configuring phone via PC
Setting the phone with
Web configurator
You can make the following settings using
the Web configurator:
u Connecting your phone to the local
network (page 109)
u Configuring for telephony
– Enter the VoIP provider settings and
configure VoIP accounts and activate/deactivate (page 111)
– Specify the name of the fixed line
network (page 116)
– Activate/deactivate the Gigaset.net
connection (page 116)
– Activate/deactivate call forwarding
for calls to your VoIP numbers or to
your Gigaset.net number
(page 121)
– Configure settings to improve voice
quality for the VoIP connections
(page 117)
– Define the standard connection for
your telephone (fixed line network
or VoIP) (page 119)
– Assign VoIP phone numbers to individual handsets as send/receive
numbers (page 120)
– Gigaset S675/S685 IP: Determine
fixed line network and VoIP phone
numbers for which the answer
machine of the base station should
record calls (page 121).
– Define user-specific dialling plans
for emergency numbers and for
cost-control purposes (page 124)
– Enter and activate/deactivate the
network mailbox for each number
assigned to the telephone
(page 126)
108
u
u
u
u
u
– Define the type of DTMF signalling
(e.g. for remote operation of a VoIP
network mailbox) and the recall key
function for VoIP (page 122)
– Enter settings for call forwarding via
VoIP (call placing, i.e. connecting
two external callers to each other,
page 123)
Output of information from an
IP info service on the handset
(page 128)
Selecting an online phone directory,
activating/deactivating the caller name
display from the online directory
(page 129)
Synchronisation of date and time on
the base station with a time server on
the Internet (page 134)
Starting firmware updates (page 132)
Managing registered handsets
– Change names and internal numbers of the registered handsets
(page 130)
– Copy contacts from your PC's Outlook address book to the handset
directories or save handset directories to your PC (page 130)
– Activate/deactivate the display of
VoIP status messages on your handset (page 132)
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / web_server.fm / 27.10.08
Web configurator –configuring phone via PC
IP Configuration
Assigning the IP address
Make the necessary settings for operating
your phone in your local network and to
connect it to the Internet. For more
detailed explanations of the individual
components/terms, see the glossary
(page 160).
¤ Open the following Web page:
Settings ¢ IP Configuration.
¤ In the Address Assignment area, select
the IP address type.
Select Obtained automatically if you want
your phone to be assigned a dynamic IP
address by a DHCP server in your local network. No further settings are necessary for
the local network.
Select Static if you would like to set up a
static IP address for your phone. A static IP
address is useful, for example, if port forwarding or a DMZ is set up on the router
for the phone.
The following fields are displayed when
you select IP address type = Static:
IP address
Enter an IP address for your phone. This
IP address allows your phone to be
reached by other subscribers in your
local network (e.g. PC).
192.168.2.2 has been preset.
Please note the following:
– The IP address must be from the
address block for private use that is
used in the router. This is generally
in the range 192.168.0.1 –
192.168.255.254 with Subnet mask
255.255.255.0. The subnet mask
determines that the first three parts
of the IP address must be identical
for all subscribers in your LAN.
– The static IP address must not
belong to the address block (IP pool
range) that is reserved for the DHCP
server of the router. It must also not
be used by another device on the
router.
If necessary, check the settings on the
router.
Subnet mask
Enter the subnet mask for your device's
IP address. For addresses from the
address block 192.168.0.1 –
192.168.255.254, the subnet mask
255.255.255.0 is generally used. This
is preconfigured when the phone is
supplied.
Default gateway
Enter the IP address for the standard
gateway, by means of which the local
network is connected with the Internet.
This is generally the local (private) IP
address for your router (e.g.
192.168.2.1). Your phone requires this
information to be able to access the
Internet.
192.168.2.1 has been preset.
Preferred DNS server
Enter the IP address for the preferred
DNS server. DNS (Domain Name System) allows you to assign public IP
addresses to symbolic names. The DNS
server is required to convert the DNS
name into the IP address when connection is being established to a server.
You can specify your router's IP address
here. The router forwards phone
address requests to its DNS server.
192.168.2.1 has been preset.
Alternate DNS server (optional)
Enter the IP address for the alternative
DNS server that should be used in situations where the preferred DNS server
cannot be reached.
Click Set to save the changes.
Click Cancel to reject the changes.
109
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / web_server.fm / 27.10.08
Web configurator –configuring phone via PC
Allowing access from other networks
The default setting for your phone is set so
that you can only access your phone's Web
configurator via a PC that is in the same
local network as your phone. The subnet
mask of the PC must match that of the
phone.
You can also allow access from PCs in
other networks.
Warning:
Expansion of access entitlement to other networks increases the risk of unauthorised
access.
It is therefore recommended that you deactivate remote access again if you no longer
require it.
¤ Open the following Web page:
Settings ¢ IP Configuration.
¤ In the Remote Management area, activate
the Yes option to permit access from
other networks.
To deactivate remote access, click the
No option. Access is then limited to PCs
in your own local network.
Access to the Web configurator services
from other networks is only possible if
your router is set accordingly. The router
must pass on the service requests from
"outside" to Port 80 (default port) of the
phone. Please also read the user guide for
your router.
To establish a connection, the public IP
address or the DNS name of the router
and, where applicable, the port number
on the router must be indicated in the
Web browser of the remote PC.
110
Configuring telephone
connections
You can configure up to eight numbers on
your phone: your fixed line network
number, your Gigaset.net number and six
VoIP numbers.
You need to set up a VoIP account with a
VoIP provider for each VoIP phone
number. You must save the access data for
each account and for the relevant VoIP
provider in the phone. You can assign a
name to each connection (VoIP and fixed
line network).
To configure the connections:
¤ Open the following Web page:
Settings ¢ Telephony ¢ Connections.
A list (see Figure 3) will be shown with all
possible connections that you can configure, or have already configured, for your
phone.
Figure 3 List of possible connections
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / web_server.fm / 27.10.08
Web configurator –configuring phone via PC
The list will show the following:
Name / Provider
Name of the connection. This will show
the name that you have defined for the
connection (page 112, page 116) or
the default name (IP1 to IP6 for VoIP
connections, Fixed Line for the fixed line
network connection and Gigaset.net).
VoIP connections also display the name
of the VoIP provider with which you
have opened the account. If the name
is unknown the display will show Other
Provider.
Suffix
Line suffix that you have to add to the
phone number of an outgoing call to
allow the account assigned to the suffix
to be used as the sending account.
Example: If you dial 123456765#1, the
connection will be made and billed
through the first VoIP account, regardless of the number you have assigned
to your handset as the send number
and whether you press briefly/press
and hold the talk key.
If you dial 123456765#0, the connection will be made via the fixed line network.
Status
The status of the connection will be
shown for VoIP connections:
Registered
The connection is activated. The phone
has been successfully registered. You
can use the connection to make calls.
Disabled
The connection is deactivated. The
phone is not registering with the corresponding account with the VoIP service. You cannot use the connection to
make or receive calls.
Registration failed / Server not accessible
Your phone was unable to register with
the VoIP service, e.g. because the VoIP
access data is incorrect or incomplete
or the phone is not connected to the
Internet. There is information about
this in the section "Questions and
answers" from page 136 onwards.
Active
You can use the option in the Active column to activate ( ) and deactivate
( ) VoIP connections. If a connection
is deactivated, the phone will not register for this connection. The connection
can be activated/deactivated by clicking
directly on the option. The change does
not need to be saved.
To configure a connection or to change
the configuration of a connection:
¤ Click Edit next to the connection.
This will open a Web page where you can
make the settings needed. More in formation is available
u in the section "Configuring the VoIP
connection" on page 111 and
u in the section "Configuring the fixed
line connection" on page 116
Configuring the VoIP connection
Open the Web page:
¤ Open the following Web page:
Settings ¢ Telephony ¢ Connections.
¤ Click Edit next to the VoIP connection
that you want to configure or the configuration of which you want to
change.
This will open a Web page where you can
make the settings that your phone needs
to access your provider's VoIP server.
The Web page always displays the
following areas:
u IP Connection (page 112),
u Auto Configuration (page 112)
u Personal Provider Data (page 113).
The areas
u General Provider Data (page 114) and
u Network (page 114)
can be shown and hidden by clicking the
Show Advanced Settings and Hide Advanced
Settings buttons.
111
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / web_server.fm / 27.10.08
Web configurator –configuring phone via PC
You must enter the VoIP provider's general
access data in these areas. You can download this data for many VoIP providers
from the Internet (see "Area: Auto Configuration").
¤ Make the settings on the Web page.
¤ Save them in the phone, see page 116.
¤ Activate the connection if necessary,
see page 116.
Area: IP Connection
Connection Name or Number
Enter a name for the VoIP connection or
the VoIP phone number (max. 16 characters). This name is used to display the
connection on the handset and the
Web configurator interface, e.g. during
allocation of send and receive numbers
(page 120), for the call display
(page 29).
Area: Auto Configuration
The entire configuration process or a large
part of the configuration for a VoIP connection is automated for many VoIP providers. You can download the necessary
VoIP access data to your telephone from
the Internet.
You have the following options:
u Fully automated configuration
Preconditions:
– You have received an auto configuration code from your VoIP provider.
– The general access data for your
VoIP provider is available for downloading.
You can download all the data required
for VoIP access from the Internet:
¤ Enter the auto configuration code
you received from your VoIP provider in the Auto Configuration area in
the Auto Configuration Code field.
¤ Click Start Auto Configuration.
112
The telephone establishes a connection to the Internet and downloads all
data required for the VoIP connection,
i.e. the general provider information
and your personal provider data
(account data) are saved to your base
station.
If further information is used on the
Web page, this is deleted as soon as
Start Auto Configuration is clicked. The
fields in the Personal Provider Data and
General Provider Data areas and the
server addresses in the Network area are
overwritten by the downloaded data.
Generally, you should not have to enter
any additional data on this Web page.
Please note:
If the message Download of settings not possible! File is corrupt! appears, no data will be
loaded onto the phone. Possible causes of
this are:
– The incorrect code has been entered
(e.g. upper/lower case rules have not
been followed). If necessary, enter the
code again.
– The file that has been downloaded is
invalid. Please consult your VoIP provider.
When the download is complete, the
Connections list will be displayed.
¤ Activate the connection as described
on page 116.
You can now be reached on the corresponding VoIP phone number.
u Automatic configuration of general
VoIP provider data
Precondition: You have received your
account details from your VoIP provider
(e.g. Authentication Name, Authentication
password).
Profile files of the most important VoIP
providers are available for download on
the Gigaset Internet server. The address
for the server is stored in your phone
(page 132).
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / web_server.fm / 27.10.08
Web configurator –configuring phone via PC
Proceed as follows to load the data
onto your telephone:
¤ In the Auto Configuration area, click
Select VoIP Provider. This will display
information on the download procedure.
Please note:
If you click the Select VoIP Provider button,
any changes that have been made to the
Web page will be saved and checked. Values
may need to be corrected before the Select
VoIP Provider operation is started.
The download procedure has several
steps:
¤ Click Next.
¤ From the list, select the country for
which the list of VoIP providers is to
be loaded.
¤ Click Next.
¤ Select your VoIP provider from the
list.
If your provider is not included in the
list, select Other Provider. In this case
you will have to enter the general
provider data by hand (see "Area:
General Provider Data" and "Area:
Network" below).
¤ Click Finish.
The details of the selected provider are
loaded to your phone and saved under
General Provider Data (page 114) and
Network (page 114). You cannot make
any further entries in these areas.
The Provider field shows the name of
the selected provider or Other Provider.
A link to the provider's homepage is displayed where available.
To complete configuration of your VoIP
connection enter your account data
under Personal Provider Data.
Area: Personal Provider Data
Enter the configuration data that is necessary for accessing your VoIP provider's SIP
service. You will receive this data from the
VoIP provider.
The field names (Authentication Name etc.)
listed in the following are standard names
and may change. If you have already
downloaded the provider's general details
("Select VoIP Provider" button, see above),
field entries will be replaced by providerspecific names to facilitate orientation
(e.g. SIP-ID instead of Authentication Name).
Authentication Name
Specify the registration or authentication ID agreed with your VoIP provider.
The registration ID serves as the access
ID that your phone must specify when
registering with the SIP proxy/registrar
server. The Authentication Name is
mainly identical to the Username, i.e. to
your Internet phone number.
Authentication password
Enter the password that you have
agreed with your VoIP provider in the
Authentication password field. The phone
needs the password when registering
with the SIP proxy/registrar server.
Username
Enter the user name (caller ID) for your
VoIP provider account. This ID is usually
identical to the first part of your SIP
address (URI, your Internet phone
number).
Example: If your SIP address is
"987654321@provider.com", enter
"987654321" in Username.
Display name (optional)
Enter any name that should be shown
in the other caller's display when you
call them via the Internet (example:
Anna Sand). All characters in the UTF8
character set (Unicode) are permitted.
The name must not exceed 32 characters.
113
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / web_server.fm / 27.10.08
Web configurator –configuring phone via PC
If you do not enter a name, your Username VoIP phone number will be displayed.
Ask your VoIP provider if this feature is
supported.
Area: General Provider Data
If you have downloaded the general settings for the VoIP provider from the
Gigaset configuration server (page 112),
then the fields in this area will be preset
with the data from the download. Generally speaking, you do not need to configure any settings in this area.
Domain
Specify the last part of your SIP address
(URI) here.
Example: For the SIP address
"987654321@provider.com", enter
"provider.com" in Domain.
Proxy server address
The SIP proxy is your VoIP provider's
gateway server. Enter the IP address or
the (fully-qualified) DNS name of your
SIP proxy server. Example: myprovider.com.
Proxy server port
Enter the number of the communication port that the SIP proxy uses to send
and receive signalling data (SIP port).
Port 5060 is used by most VoIP providers.
Registrar server
Enter the (fully-qualified) DNS name or
the IP address of the registrar server.
The registrar is needed when the
phone is registered. It assigns the public IP address/port number to your SIP
address (Username@Domain) that were
used by the phone at registration. With
most VoIP providers, the registrar
server is identical to the SIP server.
Example: reg.myprovider.com.
Registrar server port
Enter the communication port used in
the registrar. It is mainly port 5060 that
is used.
114
Registration refresh time
Enter the time intervals at which the
phone should repeat the registration
with the VoIP server (SIP proxy) (a
request will be sent to establish a session). The repeat is required so that the
entry of the phone in the tables of the
SIP proxy is retained and the phone can
therefore be reached. The repeat will
be carried out for all activated VoIP
phone numbers.
The default is 180 seconds.
If you enter 0 seconds, the registration
will not be repeated periodically.
Area: Network
Please note:
If you have downloaded the general settings
for your VoIP provider from the Gigaset configuration server (page 112), then some fields in
this area will be preset with the data from the
download (e.g. the settings for the STUN
server and outbound proxy).
If your phone is connected to a router with
NAT (Network Address Translation) and/or
a firewall, you must make some settings in
this area so that your phone can be
reached from the Internet (i.e. can be
addressed).
Through NAT, the IP addresses of subscribers in the LAN are concealed behind the
public IP address of the router.
For incoming calls
If port forwarding is activated or a DMZ is
set up for the phone on the router, no special settings are required for incoming
calls.
If this is not the case, an entry in the NAT
routing table (in the router) is necessary in
order for the phone to be reached. This
entry is created when the phone is registered with the SIP service. In the interest
of security, this entry is automatically
deleted at certain intervals (session timeout). The phone must therefore confirm
its registration at certain intervals (see
NAT refresh time, page 115), so that the
entry stays in the routing table.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / web_server.fm / 27.10.08
Web configurator –configuring phone via PC
For outgoing calls
The phone needs its public address in
order to receive caller voice data.
There are two possibilities:
u The phone requests the public address
from a STUN server on the Internet
(Simple Transversal of UDP over NAT).
STUN can only be used with asymmetric NATs and non-blocking firewalls.
u The phone does not direct the connection request to the SIP proxy but to an
outbound proxy on the Internet that
supplies the data packets along with
the public address.
The STUN server and outbound proxy are
used alternately to work around the NAT/
firewall in the router.
STUN enabled
Click Yes if you want your phone to use
STUN as soon as it is used on a router
with asymmetric NAT.
STUN server
Enter the (fully-qualified) DNS name or
the IP address of the STUN server on
the Internet.
If you selected Yes in the STUN enabled
field, you must enter a STUN server
here.
STUN port
Enter the number of the communication port on the STUN server. The
default port is 3478.
STUN refresh time
Enter the time intervals at which the
phone should repeat the registration
with the STUN server. The repeat is
required so that the entry of the phone
in the tables of the STUN server is
retained. The repeat will be carried out
for all activated VoIP phone numbers.
Ask your VoIP provider for the STUN
refresh time.
The default is 240 seconds.
If you enter 0 seconds, the registration
will not be repeated periodically.
NAT refresh time
Specify the intervals at which you want
the phone to update its entry in the
NAT routing table. Specify an interval in
seconds that is a little smaller than the
NAT session timeout.
As a rule you should not change the
preconfigured value for the NAT refresh
time.
Outbound proxy mode
Specify when the outbound proxy
should be used.
Always
All signalling and voice data sent by the
phone is sent to the outbound proxy.
Auto
Data sent by the phone is only sent to
the outbound proxy when the phone is
connected to a router with symmetric
NAT or blocking firewall. If the phone is
behind an asymmetric NAT, the STUN
server is used.
If you have set STUN enabled = No or
have not entered a STUN server, the
outbound proxy is always used.
Never
The outbound proxy is not used.
If you do not make an entry in the Outbound proxy field, the phone behaves
independently of the selected mode, as
with Never.
Outbound proxy
Enter the (fully qualified) DNS name or
the IP address of your provider's outbound proxy.
Please note:
With many providers, the outbound proxy is
identical to the SIP proxy.
Outbound proxy port
Enter the number of the communication port used by the outbound proxy.
The default port is 5060.
115
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / web_server.fm / 27.10.08
Web configurator –configuring phone via PC
Saving settings on the phone
¤ Click Set to save the changes.
The Connections list will be shown after
saving (see Figure 3 on page 110).
If you want to reject the changes that have
been made, click Cancel.
Clicking the Delete button will reset all the
values back to their default settings. Fields
with default settings are empty.
Please note: If you do not make any
entries for a lengthy period, the connection to the Web configurator is automatically terminated. Unsaved entries are lost.
If necessary, implement temporary security measures. You can subsequently continue the entry and make changes if necessary.
Activating a new connection
If you have configured a new VoIP connection, you must also activate it.
In the Connections list:
¤ Activate the relevant option in the
Active column ( = activated).
Your phone will register itself with the
VoIP provider using the relevant access
data. Update the Web page (e.g. by pressing F5). The Status Registered column will
appear if registration was successful. You
can now be reached on this VoIP phone
number.
Please note:
Once the new entry has been made, the VoIP
phone number is assigned to each handset
and also the integrated answer machine as a
receive number. For how to adjust the assignment, see page 120.
Configuring the fixed line connection
You can assign a name to your fixed line
connection. This name is used to display
the connection on the handset and the
Web configurator interface, e.g. during
allocation of send and receive numbers
(page 120), for the call display (page 29).
116
¤ Open the following Web page:
Settings ¢ Telephony ¢ Connections.
¤ In the Fixed Line Connection area, click
the Edit button.
¤ Enter your fixed line network number
or the name of your choice (max. 16
characters) for your fixed line connection in the Connection Name or Number
field. The default is "Fixed Line".
Activating/deactivating the
Gigaset.net connection
Your phone is assigned a Gigaset.net
phone number on delivery. As soon as you
have connected your phone to the Internet, you can make calls using the
Gigaset.net and receive calls from other
Gigaset.net subscribers, provided that
your Gigaset.net connection has been
activated. You can deactivate the
Gigaset.net connection.
¤ Open the following Web page:
Settings ¢ Telephony ¢ Connections.
The list of connections will be displayed
(see Figure 3 on page 110).
¤ In the Gigaset.net area: use the option in
the Active column to activate ( ) or
deactivate ( ) the Gigaset.net connection.
Please note:
If you do not use your Gigaset.net connection
for six weeks, it is automatically deactivated.
You cannot be reached for calls from the
Gigaset.net.
The connection is re-activated:
– as soon as you start a search in the
Gigaset.net directory (page 34) or
– make a call via Gigaset.net, i.e. dial a
number ending in #9 (two attempts may be
necessary) or
– activate the connection via the Web configurator as described above.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / web_server.fm / 27.10.08
Web configurator –configuring phone via PC
Optimising voice quality for
VoIP connections
You can make general and connectionspecific settings to improve the voice quality for VoIP telephony.
¤ Open the following Web page:
Settings ¢ Telephony ¢ Audio.
The voice quality for VoIP connections is
mainly determined by the voice codec
used for transferring the data and the
available bandwidth of your DSL connection.
In the case of the voice codec, the voice
data is digitalised (coded/decoded) and
compressed. A "better" codec (better voice
quality) means more data needs to be
transferred, i.e. perfect voice data transfer
requires a DSL connection with a larger
bandwidth.
The following voice codecs are supported
by your phone:
G.722
Excellent voice quality. The broadband
speech codec G.722 works at the same
bit rate as G.711 (64 kbit/s per speech
connection) but with a higher sampling
rate. This allows higher frequencies to
be played back. The speech tone is
therefore clearer and better than for
the other codecs (High Definition
Sound Performance).
G.711 a law / G.711 µ law
Excellent voice quality (comparable
with ISDN). The necessary bandwidth is
64 kbit/s per voice connection.
G.726
Good voice quality (inferior to that with
G.711 but better than with G.729).
Your phone supports G.726 with a
transmission rate of 32 kbit/s per voice
connection.
G.729
Average voice quality. The necessary
bandwidth is less than 8 kbit/s per voice
connection.
Both sides of a phone connection (caller/
sender side and receiver side) must use
the same voice codec. The voice codec is
negotiated between the sender and the
recipient when establishing a connection.
You can influence the voice quality by
selecting (bearing in mind the bandwidth
of your DSL connection) the voice codecs
your phone is to use, and specifying the
order in which the codecs are to be suggested when a VoIP connection is established.
Area: Settings for Bandwidth
The settings in this area influence all VoIP
connections (VoIP phone numbers).
Allow 1 VoIP call only
You can usually make two VoIP calls at
the same time on your phone. If, however, your DSL connection has a narrow
bandwidth, there may be problems if
two VoIP calls are made at the same
time. The data is no longer transferred
properly (long voice delay, data losses
etc.).
¤ Activate Yes next to Allow 1 VoIP call
only to prevent any further parallel
VoIP phone connections being
established.
¤ If you wish to permit two VoIP connections, activate the No option.
Please note: If only one VoIP connection is
permitted, the following VoIP network services
are no longer available:
– Call waiting
Call waiting is not displayed during a call via
VoIP
– External consultation call from a VoIP call
– Toggling and initiating a conference call via
VoIP
117
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / web_server.fm / 27.10.08
Web configurator –configuring phone via PC
Voice Quality
Default settings for the codecs used are
stored in your phone: one setting optimised for narrow and one for wide
bandwidths.
¤ Activate one of the options Optimized
for low bandwidth / Optimized for high
bandwidth if you wish to accept a
default setting for all VoIP connections. The settings are shown in the
Settings for Connections area and cannot be changed.
¤ Activate the Own Codec preference
option if you wish to select and set
connection-specific voice codecs
yourself (see "Area: Settings for Connections").
Area: Settings for Connections
In this area you can make specific settings
for each of your VoIP phone numbers.
You can make the following settings for
each VoIP phone number configured on
your phone:
Volume for VoIP Calls
Depending on the VoIP provider, it is
possible that the received voice/earpiece volume is too low or too high, so
that adjusting the volume via the handset is not adequate.
Specify whether the received volume
range is too high or too low. The following options are available:
Low
Voice/earpiece volume is too high. Activate this option to reduce the volume
by 6 dB.
Normal
The voice/earpiece volume does not
need to be raised/lowered.
High
Voice/earpiece volume is too low. Activate this option to increase the volume
by 6 dB.
118
Voice codecs
Precondition: The Own Codec preference
option is activated for the Voice Quality
in the Settings for Bandwidth area.
Select the voice codecs your phone is to
use, and specify the order in which the
codecs are to be suggested when a VoIP
connection is established via this VoIP
phone number.
¤ Apply the voice codecs that your
phone is to suggest with outgoing
calls into the Selected codecs list.
To do this, in the Available codecs list
click the voice codec that you want
to apply (you can mark several
entries using the Shift key or the Ctrl
key). Click <Add.
¤ Move the voice codecs that you do
not want the phone to use into the
Available codecs list.
Also, select the voice codecs in the
Selected codecs list (see above) and
click Remove>.
¤ Sort the voice codecs in the Selected
codecs list into the order in which
they should be suggested to the
receiving device when a connection
is established. To do this, use the Up
and Down buttons.
When establishing a VoIP connection,
the phone suggests the 1st voice codec
in the Selected codecs list to the receiving device to begin with. If the receiving device does not accept the codec
(e.g. because it is not supported), the
2nd voice codec on the list is suggested, and so on.
If the receiving device does not accept
any of the voice codecs in the Selected
codecs list, the connection is not established. An appropriate message will be
displayed on the handset.
If the phone always starts by trying to
establish a broadband connection, put
the G.722 codec at the top of the list
Selected codecs.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / web_server.fm / 27.10.08
Web configurator –configuring phone via PC
Please note:
– You should only deactivate codecs (put
them in the Available codecs list) if there is a
particular reason. The more codecs that are
deactivated, the greater the danger that
calls will not be able to be established due
to unsuccessful codec negotiations. In particular you can only establish broadband
connections if you permit the G.722 codec
– With incoming calls, all supported voice
codecs are always permitted.
Area: Settings for Codecs
To save additional bandwidth and transmission capacity, on VoIP connections that
use the G.729 codec you can suppress the
transmission of voice packets in pauses
("Silence Suppression"). Then, instead of
the background noises in your environment, your caller hears a synthetic noise
generated in the receiver.
Please note: "Silence Suppression" can
sometimes lead to deterioration in the
voice quality.
¤ In the Enable Annex B for codec G.729
field, state whether the transmission of
data packets during pauses should be
suppressed when using the G.729
codec, (activate Yes).
Saving settings on the phone
Voice quality and infrastructure
With your Gigaset S685/S675 IP you have
the opportunity to make calls with good
voice quality via VoIP.
However, your phone's performance with
VoIP – and therefore the voice quality –
also depends on the properties of the
entire infrastructure.
The following VoIP provider components
are just some of the things that can influence performance:
u Router
u DSLAM
u DSL transmission line and speed
u Connection paths over the Internet
u If necessary, other applications that
also use the DSL connection
In VoIP networks, voice quality is affected
by various things including the "quality of
service" (QoS). If the entire infrastructure
demonstrates QoS, voice quality is better
(fewer delays, less echoing, less crackling
etc.).
If, for example, the router does not have
QoS, then the voice quality is not as good.
Please see the specialist documentation
for further information.
¤ Click Set to save the settings for the
Setting the telephone default
connection
Please note:
The default telephone connection defines
which line type (VoIP or fixed line network) will be used to dial numbers when
you briefly press the key. The default
connection is applied to all registered
handsets.
¤ Open the following Web page: Settings
¢ Telephony ¢ Number Assignment.
¤ Enter the default connection in the
Linetype for outgoing calls area. This can
be done by clicking on the VoIP or Fixed
Line option.
¤ Now click Set to activate your settings.
voice quality.
You should observe the following for good
voice quality:
– When making calls using VoIP, avoid performing other Internet activities (e.g. surfing the Internet).
– Irrespective of the codec used and the network capacity utilisation, please note that
voice delays can occur.
119
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / web_server.fm / 27.10.08
Web configurator –configuring phone via PC
Please note:
– The default connection is only relevant
when dialling numbers that are not subject
to dialling plans and are entered without a
line suffix.
– You can change the settings for the default
connection via any registered Gigaset handset (page 98)
Assigning send and receive
numbers to handsets
You can assign up to eight numbers on
your phone: your fixed line network
number, your Gigaset.net number and six
VoIP numbers.
You can assign as many of these numbers
as you like to each handset as receive
numbers. Receive numbers determine
which handset(s) will ring when a call is
received.
You can assign one of your VoIP numbers
to each handset as a (VoIP) send number.
Send numbers define which VoIP account
should be used in general to make and pay
for outgoing VoIP calls. Exceptions:
u A phone number is dialled with a line
suffix (page 111) or
u A dialling plan has been defined for the
phone number (page 124).
The Gigaset.net number and fixed line
network number are permanently
assigned to each registered handset.
Please note:
A handset is assigned the following numbers
after it is registered on the base station:
– Receive numbers: all phone numbers
assigned to the phone (fixed line network,
Gigaset.net and VoIP).
– Send numbers: the fixed line network
number and the VoIP phone number that
you entered at the start of the phone configuration.
¤ Open the following Web page: Settings
¢ Telephony ¢ Number Assignment.
120
The display shows all registered handsets.
A list is displayed for each handset showing the phone numbers that are configured and activated for the phone. The connection names are shown in the Connections column. The fixed line network connection is always at the end of the list.
¤ Define a VoIP phone number as the
send number for each handset. To do
this, click the option following the
phone number in the for outgoing calls
column. The previous assignment will
automatically be deactivated.
Please note:
The fixed line network number is permanently assigned to each handset as a send
number. This assignment cannot be deactivated. It ensures that emergency calls can
be made from every handset.
The Gigaset.net number is also permanently assigned to each handset.
¤ Select the phone numbers for each
¤
handset (fixed line network, VoIP) that
are to be assigned to the handset as
receive numbers. To do this, click the
option following the phone number in
the for incoming calls column. Every
handset can be assigned several phone
numbers or no phone number
( = assigned).
Now click Set to save your settings.
Please note:
– If a VoIP phone number that has been
assigned to a handset as a send number is
deleted, then the handset will automatically be assigned the first configured VoIP
phone number.
– Calls made to a number that is not assigned
to a handset as a receive number will not be
signalled on any handset.
– If you have not assigned receive numbers
to any of the handsets, calls to all connections will be signalled on all handsets.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / web_server.fm / 27.10.08
Web configurator –configuring phone via PC
Gigaset S675/S685 IP:
assigning receive numbers to
the answer machine
You can specify for which of your phone
numbers your telephone's answer
machine is to accept the calls. To do this,
assign receive numbers to the answer
machine.
Please note:
– Once the new entry has been made, each
VoIP phone number is assigned to the integrated answer machine as a receive
number.
– If no receive number is assigned to the
answer machine, it will not accept any calls
even if it is activated.
– For how to set and operate the answer
machine, see page 61.
¤ Open the following Web page: Settings
¢ Telephony ¢ Number Assignment.
¤ In the Answering machine area, select
¤
the phone numbers (fixed line network, VoIP) for which the answer
machine is to accept calls (if it is activated, see page 61). To do this, click
the option following the phone
number in the for incoming calls column.
You can assign as many numbers as
you wish to the answer machine ( =
assigned).
Now click Set to save your settings.
Activating Call Forwarding for
VoIP connections
You can define if and when calls to your
Gigaset.net number and some of your
VoIP numbers (VoIP account) should be
forwarded to this VoIP number.
You can also use the handset to define call
forwarding and activate/deactivate it, see
page 39.
¤ Open the following Web page:
Settings ¢ Telephony ¢ Call Forwarding.
The display shows a list of all your VoIP
connections and your Gigaset.net
number.
Connections
Select the name you have assigned to
the VoIP number, or select Gigaset.net.
When
Select when a call to this number
should be forwarded: When busy / No
reply / Always. Select Off to deactivate
call forwarding.
Call number
Enter the phone number to which the
calls should be forwarded. Please note
that you may have to enter the area
code when forwarding to a fixed line
network number in the same area
(depending on your VoIP provider and
the setting for the automatic area code,
see page 123).
The settings only affect the selected
phone number.
Please note:
For how to forward your fixed line network
number, see page 37.
You can forward calls to your VoIP numbers and to your Gigaset.net number.
You can forward calls to your VoIP numbers to any external number (VoIP, fixed
line or mobile network number). The forwarding is done via a VoIP connection.
You can forward calls to your Gigaset.net
number within the Gigaset.net, i.e. to
another Gigaset.net number.
121
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / web_server.fm / 27.10.08
Web configurator –configuring phone via PC
Setting the DTMF-reminder for
VoIP
DTMF signalling is required, for example,
for querying and controlling certain network mailboxes via digit codes or for
remote operation of the integrated
answer machine.
To send DTMF signals via VoIP you must
first define how key codes should be converted into and sent as DTMF signals: as
audible information via the speech channel or as "SIP Info" message.
Ask your VoIP provider which type of
DTMF transmission it supports.
¤ Open the following Web page: Settings
¢ Telephony ¢ Advanced Settings.
In the DTMF over VoIP connections area,
make the required settings for sending
DTMF signals.
¤ Activate Audio or RFC 2833, if DTMF signals are to be transmitted acoustically
(in voice packets).
¤ Activate SIP Info if DTMF signals are to
be transmitted as code.
¤ Now click Set to save your settings.
Please note:
– The settings for DTMF signalling apply to all
VoIP connections (VoIP accounts).
– DTMF signals can not be transmitted in the
audio path (Audio) on broadband connections (the G.722 codec is used).
Defining recall key functions for
VoIP (hook flash)
Your VoIP provider may support special
performance features. To make use of
these features, your phone needs to send
a specific signal (data packet) to the SIP
server. You can assign this "signal" to your
phone's recall key.
If you press the recall key during a VoIP call
the signal will be sent to the server.
122
¤ Open the following Web page: Settings
¢ Telephony ¢ Advanced Settings.
¤ Enter the data you received from your
VoIP provider into the Application Type
and Application Signal fields in the Hook
Flash (R-key) area.
¤ Now click Set to save your settings.
The setting for the recall key applies to all
registered handsets.
Defining local communication
ports for VoIP
¤ Open the following Web page: Settings
¢ Telephony ¢ Advanced Settings.
In the Listen ports for VoIP connections area,
specify which local ports the telephone is
to use for VoIP telephony. The ports must
not be used by any other subscriber in the
LAN.
SIP port
Specify the local communication port
that the phone should use to send and
receive signalling data. Specify a
number between 1024 and 49152. The
default port number for SIP signalling is
5060.
RTP port
Specify the local communication port
that the phone should use to receive
voice data. Enter an even number
between 1024 and 49152. The port
number must not be the same as the
port number in the SIP port field. If you
enter an odd number, the next lowest
even number will be selected automatically (e.g. you enter 5003, then 5002
is set automatically). The default port
number for voice transmission is 5004.
Use random ports
Click the Yes option if you do not want
the phone to use fixed ports for SIP port
and RTP port, but rather to use any free
ports.
The use of random ports makes sense
if you want several phones to be operated on the same router with NAT.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / web_server.fm / 27.10.08
Web configurator –configuring phone via PC
The phones must then use different
ports so that the router's NAT is only
able to forward incoming calls and
voice data to one (the intended)
phone.
If you click No, the phone will use the
ports specified in SIP port and RTP port.
Automatic Refer To
If you activate Yes, the base station will
attempt to determine the best protocol
automatically.
If the base station cannot determine
the best protocol, it will use the protocol defined in Preferred Refer To.
¤ Now click Set to save your settings.
¤ Now click Set to save your settings.
Configuring call forwarding
via VoIP
Setting area code predialling
If you are toggling calls via VoIP connections, you can connect the two external
callers (provider-dependent). You can
configure settings for this type of call forwarding.
¤ Open the following Web page: Settings
¢ Telephony ¢ Advanced Settings.
¤ Configure the following settings in the
Call Transfer area for call forwarding via
VoIP:
Transfer Call by On-Hook
If you activate Yes, the external parties
you are toggling between will be connected when you press the end call key
. Your connections with the callers
will be terminated.
To learn how to forward a call when
you have activated No, please see
page 40.
Preferred Refer To
Define the protocol (the contents of the
"Refer To" information) that should be
used with preference when forwarding
calls:
Target’s contact info
This protocol is recommended for
"closed" networks (internal company
and business networks).
Original URL
This protocol is recommended when
the base station is connected to the
Internet via a router with NAT.
On the base station, save the complete
code (with international code) for the area
in which you are using the phone.
For VoIP calls you must generally always
dial the area code – even for local calls.
You can save the need to dial the area
code for local calls by setting your phone
to prefix this code for all VoIP calls made in
the same local area.
For calls made via VoIP, the area code
entered is then prefixed to all numbers
that do not start with 0 — even when dialling numbers from the directory and other
lists. Exceptions: Numbers for which you
have defined dialling plans (page 124).
¤ Open the following Web page: Settings
¢ Telephony ¢ Dialling Plans.
Configure the following settings in the
Area Codes area:
¤ From the Country list, select the country
in which you are using your phone.
This way the country code and the prefix of the area code are automatically
set (in International Prefix / Area Code and
Local Prefix fields).
¤ In the Local Area Code field enter the
¤
area code for your town without a prefix, e.g. 20 (for London).
Click Yes next to Predial area code for local
calls through VoIP to activate the function.
123
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / web_server.fm / 27.10.08
Web configurator –configuring phone via PC
¤
Click No to deactivate the function. You
will then need to enter the area code
for local calls made via VoIP. Numbers
in the directory must always contain
the area code for dialling via VoIP.
Click Set to save the settings.
Please note:
u The area code will also be prefixed to
VoIP calls made to emergency numbers if there are no defined dialling
plans for these numbers.
u The numbers of your network mailbox
saved in the base station are not prefixed with a code (page 126).
Defining dialling plans –
cost control
You can define dialling plans to reduce
costs:
u You can define the connection (one of
your VoIP accounts, the fixed line network) through which calls to specific
numbers should be made and paid for.
If you enter just a few digits (e.g. area,
national or mobile network code) any
call to a number beginning with these
digits will be made via the elected connection.
u You can block specific numbers, i.e.
your phone will not establish a connection to these numbers (e.g. 0900 numbers).
These dialling plans apply to all registered
handsets. The settings for the default connection (briefly press/press and hold )
and the send numbers of handsets do not
apply to numbers governed by a dialling
plan.
124
Please note:
You can override dialling plans, with the exception of blocks, as follows:
– Dial the number with a line suffix
(e.g. 123456789#3, see page 27).
– Before you enter the number, define a different connection type by pressing the display keys §FixedLine§ / §IP§ (page 87).
If, for e.g., you press §FixedLine§, the number
will be dialled via the fixed line network,
even if the dialling plan states that a VoIP
connection should be used.
Area code predialling is not prefixed to numbers
governed by a dialling plan (page 123).
Tips:
u Compare the rates for long-distance
calls (especially for international calls)
offered by your fixed line network and
VoIP providers, and determine which
connection should be used specifically
for these countries/locations, e.g. a
dialling plan for the Phone Number
"0033" would apply to every call made
to France.
u Use dialling plans to define that numbers starting with a call-by-call number
are always made via your fixed line network connection. To do so, enter the
call-by-call number in the Phone Number
field.
Defining dialling plans
¤ Open the following Web page:
Settings ¢ Telephony ¢ Dialling Plans.
You can define dialling plans for your telephone in the Dialling Plans area. Specify
the following:
Phone Number
Enter the number or the first digits of
the phone number (e.g. an area code)
to which the dialling plan should apply
(max. 15 digits).
Enter each phone number and the area
code, even if you have activated the
Predial area code for local calls through
VoIP (page 123) function.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / web_server.fm / 27.10.08
Web configurator –configuring phone via PC
Connection Type
The list shows all the VoIP connections
that you have configured as well as
your fixed line network connection. It
also displays the name assigned to
each connection.
¤ From the list, select the connection
via which the number or numbers
that start with the sequence of digits
should be dialled.
Or:
¤ Select Block if the number or numbers that start with the sequence of
digits should be blocked.
The display will show Not possible! if an
attempt is made to dial a blocked
number.
Comment (optional)
You can enter a description of up to
20 characters for the dialling plan here.
¤ Click Add.
The dialling plan is activated immediately.
A new empty line for a new dialling plan
will appear if your phone still has enough
space.
Please note:
If dialling plans overlap, the one with the
greatest concordance will apply.
Example: There is a dialling plan for the
number "02" and one for the number "023". If
you dial "0231..." the second plan will apply; if
you dial "0208..." the first plan will apply.
Examples:
u You want to block your phone for all
0900 numbers.
Dialling plan:
Phone Number = 0900 Connection
Type = Block
u All calls to the mobile phone network
shall be made via your VoIP connection
with provider B.
Dialling plans:
Phone Number = 017
Connection Type = IP3, provider B
and the corresponding entries for "015"
and "016".
Activating/deactivating dialling plans
¤ Click the option in the Active column to
activate/deactivate the corresponding
dialling plan ( = activated).
A deactivated dialling plan will not take
effect until it is re-activated.
Deleting dialling plans
¤ Click Delete next to the dialling plan you
wish to delete.
The dialling plan is deleted from the list
immediately. The space in the list is
released.
Please note:
Predefined dialling plans set as defaults (for
emergency numbers cannot be deactivated
and cannot be deleted.
Emergency numbers
Dialling plans for emergency numbers
(e.g. the local emergency service
number) are factory-set for certain countries. The fixed line network is determined
as the Connection Type.
These dialling plans cannot be deleted,
deactivated or blocked. However, you can
change the Connection Type.
This should only be changed if the phone
is not connected to the fixed line network.
If you choose a VoIP connection, please
make sure the VoIP provider supports
emergency calls.
If no emergency numbers are set by
default, you should define dialling plans
for emergency numbers yourself and
assign them to a connection of which you
know that it supports emergency calls.
Emergency calls are always supported by
fixed line networks.
125
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / web_server.fm / 27.10.08
Web configurator –configuring phone via PC
Warning:
– Emergency numbers cannot be dialled if
the keypad lock is activated. Before dialling,
press and hold the hash key , to
release the keypad lock.
– If you have activated an automatic area
code (page 123) and if no dialling plan for
emergency calls is defined, the area code
will also be prefixed to emergency calls
made via VoIP.
Activating/deactivating network
mailbox, entering numbers
Many fixed line network providers and
VoIP providers offer answer machines on
the network – these are known as network
mailboxes.
Each network mailbox accepts incoming
calls made via the corresponding line
(fixed line network or corresponding VoIP
phone number).
You can enter the relevant network mailbox for each configured connection (VoIP,
fixed line network) via the Web configurator. You can activate or deactivate the network mailbox for your VoIP connections.
¤ Open the following Web page: Settings
¢ Telephony ¢ Network Mailbox.
A list with all possible connections is displayed on the Web page. The names of the
connections are displayed in the Connection column.
Entering numbers
¤ Enter the network mailbox number in
¤
the Call number column after the
desired connection.
With some VoIP providers your mailbox
number will be downloaded together
with the general VoIP provider data
(page 112), saved to your base station
and displayed under Call number.
Now click Set to save your settings.
126
Activating/deactivating the network
mailbox
¤ You can activate (
‰ ) and deactivate
(
) individual VoIP network mailboxes using the option in the Active column. Activating/deactivating is carried
out by clicking on the appropriate
option. The change does not need to be
saved.
Please note:
– You need to have requested the network
mailbox for your fixed line network connection from your fixed line network provider.
– For how to enter the network mailbox numbers and activate/deactivate network mailboxes, please see page 78.
Saving messenger access data
The messenger client in your base station
enables instant messaging (immediate
message transfer, chatting). The phone
supports the XMPP messenger (Jabber).
In order for you to use your phone's messenger to "go online" and "chat" on the
Internet, the access data of a messenger
server must be saved on your phone.
Your phone is already registered with the
Gigaset.net Jabber server. An account has
been assigned to your phone. You can
chat to other Gigaset.net subscribers via
this account. To do this you need to create
a buddy list on the PC (see "Setting up
Gigaset.net Jabber account" on
page 127).
You can also register with another instant
messaging provider that supports XMPP
Messenger (Jabber). You must then save
the messenger server address and your
access data on your phone.
You can define a Resource name and a Priority for your phone. Both are required if
you are logged in (online) with the messenger server with several devices (phone,
desktop PC and laptop) at the same time
using the same Jabber ID.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / web_server.fm / 27.10.08
Web configurator –configuring phone via PC
The Resource name is used to distinguish
between these devices. The phone cannot
log in with the messenger server if it does
not have a resource name.
You should assign a Priority as each message will only be sent to one device for
each Jabber ID. The Priority determines
which of the devices receives the message.
Example: You are online using one of your
phone's handsets and your PC both at the
same time. You have assigned your phone
(Resource name "phone") Priority 5 and your
PC (Resource name "PC") Priority 10. In this
case, any message addressed to your Jabber ID will be sent to your phone.
¤ Open the following Web page:
Settings ¢ Messaging ¢ Messenger.
¤ In the Messenger Account field, select
¤
¤
whether you wish to use the Gigaset.net
Jabber server or another provider's
messenger server (Other).
The access data for Gigaset.net is already
stored in the base station. It is displayed in Jabber ID, Authentication password and Jabber server. With this data
you can also register with the
Gigaset.net Jabber server through your
PC.
Enter the user ID (max. 50 characters)
and password (max. 20 characters) that
you used to register with the messenger server in the Jabber ID and Authentication password fields. If you have
selected Messenger Account =
Gigaset.net, the fields are preconfigured
with your Gigaset.net account.
In the Jabber server field, enter the IP
address or the DNS name of the messenger server with which you are registered for instant messaging.
Max. 74 alphanumeric characters.
If you have selected Messenger Account =
Gigaset.net, the field is preconfigured
with the name of the Gigaset.net
server.
¤ Enter the number of the communica-
¤
¤
¤
tion port on the Jabber server in the
Jabber server port field. The default port
is 5222.
If you have selected Messenger Account =
Gigaset.net, the port number is preconfigured.
Enter a resource name (max. 20 characters) in the Resource field.
The default is: phone.
Enter the priority for your phone in the
Priority field. Select a number between 128 (highest priority) and 127 (lowest
priority) for the priority.
The default is: 5
Click Set.
Setting up Gigaset.net Jabber account
Your phone is already registered with the
Gigaset.net Jabber server. An account has
been assigned to your phone.
In order to chat with other Gigaset.net
subscribers via this account, you must
transfer the required Gigaset.net subscribers to a contact list (buddy list) on your PC.
You can use any conventional Jabber client for this (e.g. PSI, Miranda; see e.g.
http://www.swissjabber.ch).
Do the following so you can use your
Gigaset.net Jabber account:
¤ Start the Web configurator, open the
Settings ¢ Messaging ¢ Messenger
Web page and select Messenger Account
Gigaset.net in the field. Your account
data is displayed in Jabber ID and
Authentication password. You will need
these to create a buddy list via the
Jabber client on the PC.
¤ Start your Jabber client on the PC.
¤ Enter your Gigaset.net Jabber ID on the
Jabber client as a new account. The Jabber ID consists of your Gigaset.net
number and "@jabber.gigaset.net"
Example:
12345678901#9@jabber.gigaset.net
¤ Then enter your Authentication password.
127
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / web_server.fm / 27.10.08
Web configurator –configuring phone via PC
Please note:
– Do not select the option "Create new
account". Your Gigaset.net Jabber account
has already been created in Gigaset.net.
– The option "SSL connection" must be deactivated in the Jabber client.
¤ Now you can enter Gigaset.net sub-
scribers as contacts (buddies).
For the Jabber ID of each subscriber,
enter the subscriber's Gigaset.net
number with "@jabber.gigaset.net"
(example: 2141524901#9@jabber.gigaset.net).
A request to "Add to contact list" will be
sent to the subscriber.
If the subscriber accepts this request, they
will be added to your buddy list. This
updated buddy list will be displayed on the
handset the next time the messenger is
rebooted. To restart: If necessary, close
your connection to the messenger server
(page 73) and then go back online
(page 72).
Please note:
For how to use your handset to go online and
chat with or call buddies, see page 71.
Making e-mail settings
You can use your phone to be notified
about new e-mail messages on your
incoming e-mail server (page 68).
You must store the address or DNS name
of your incoming e-mail server and your
personal access data in the phone and
activate the e-mail check with the incoming e-mail server, so that the phone can
establish a connection to the incoming email server and connect to your mailbox.
¤ Open the following Web page:
Settings ¢ Messaging ¢ E-Mail.
¤ Enter the user name (account name)
agreed with the Internet provider (max.
50 characters) in the Authentication
Name field.
128
¤ Enter the password that you agreed
¤
¤
¤
with your provider for accessing the
incoming e-mail server (max. 20 characters; case sensitive) in the Authentication password field.
Enter the name of the incoming e-mail
server (POP3 server) (max. 74 characters) in the POP3 Server field. Example:
pop.theserver.com.
From the Check for new e-mail list select
the time interval at which your phone
should check if new messages have
arrived in your incoming e-mail server.
Select Never to deactivate the prompt.
Select one of the other values to activate the prompt for new e-mail messages.
Click the Set button to save the settings
in your phone.
Please note:
For how to show the messages from your mailbox on your handset, see page 68
Activating/deactivating info
services
You can configure your registered
Gigaset S67H/S68H handsets to display
customised text information (e.g. weather
reports, RSS feeds) on the idle display.
Precondition: The Clock is set as a screensaver on the handset (page 86).
Incoming text information will overwrite
the screensaver.
You can activate and deactivate the display of text information for every handset.
¤ Open the following Web page:
Settings ¢ Services.
¤ In the Info services on screensaver area,
activate Yes / No to activate or deactivate the display of text information.
¤ Click the Set button to save the settings
in your phone.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / web_server.fm / 27.10.08
Web configurator –configuring phone via PC
Configuring info services
Please note:
The weather report is preset. It is shown in the
handset's idle display as soon as you set the
Clock as a screensaver.
¤ Click the link
www.gigaset.net/myaccount
or enter the URL into the address field
of a different browser window.
¤ Enter the account data shown in the
Info services on screensaver area into the
fields for the user account.
This will open a Web page where you can
compile your info service.
¤ Define which information should be
sent regularly to your handset.
Selecting and registering online
directories for access
You can use online directories (net directory and yellow pages) on your handset.
You can use your telephone's Web configurator to define which online directory
you wish to use.
You can also elect to display the name
under which the caller making an incoming call is saved in the online or
Gigaset.net directory (Display of caller’s
name) – in the call display and in the caller
list. Precondition: This function is supported by the provider of the online directory.
¤ Open the following Web page:
Settings ¢ Services.
¤
The following fields are displayed depending on the Provider you select:
Display of caller’s name
This is displayed if the provider supports transmission of the caller name
from the online directory to the call display (page 30).
¤ Click on On to update the display.
Authentication Name, Authentication
password
These are displayed if you need to register with the provider to gain access to
certain services:
– Some providers require you to register every time you want to access
their online directory. They require
registration with user name and
password for access to the online
directory. You will need to save this
data to your base station.
– Other providers differentiate
between standard and premium
services. You can access standard
services without first entering user
name and password.
But you will have to register to use
the premium services. You will need
to save the access data to your base
station to gain access to premium
services.
¤ Enter the details you received from
your provider in the Authentication
Name and Authentication password
fields.
¤ Click the Set button to save the settings
in your phone.
The settings are made in the Online
Directory area.
Select the provider whose online directory you wish to use from the Provider
list. Select "---" if you do not wish to use
an online directory.
129
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / web_server.fm / 27.10.08
Web configurator –configuring phone via PC
Please note:
– How to use online directories on handsets,
see page 45.
– The provider-specific name of the online
directory and classified directory are displayed in the list of online directories on the
handset (press and hold ).
– The handset directories (press briefly)
always display the entries Net Directory and
Yellow Pages for online and classified directories (regardless of the selected provider).
However, connections are made to the
selected online directories.
– If you select "---" from the Provider list the
entries for online and classified directories
will not be displayed in the handset's list of
online directories.
The directory entries Net Directory and Yellow
Pages are maintained but cannot be used to
make any connections.
Changing internal handset
numbers and names
Each handset is automatically assigned
an internal number (1 to 6) and an internal name ("INT 1", "INT 2" etc.) when it registers with the base station (page 81).
The internal numbers and names of all
registered handsets can be changed.
Please note:
You can read how to change internal names
and numbers from page 82 onwards.
¤ Open the following Web page:
Settings ¢ Handsets.
The names and internal numbers of all
registered handsets are displayed in the
Registered Handsets area.
¤ Select the handset whose number/
name you want to change.
¤ Changing numbers: Select the internal number that you want to assign to
the handset in the No. column of the
handset. If a handset with this internal
number already exists, you will also
have to change the number allocation
for this handset. The internal numbers
1-6 can only be assigned once each.
130
¤ Changing names: If necessary, change
the name of the handset in the Name
column. The name may contain up to
10 characters.
¤ If necessary, repeat the process for
other handsets.
¤ Click Set to save the settings.
The changes are present in the internal
lists of all registered handsets. Handsets
are sorted by their internal numbers in the
internal list. The order of the handsets in
the list can therefore be changed.
Please note:
If an internal number has been entered twice,
a message will appear. The internal numbers
are not changed.
Loading and deleting handset
directories to/from the PC
The Web configurator has the following
options for editing the directories of the
registered handsets.
u Store the handset directories on a PC.
Entries are stored in vCard format in a
vcf file on the PC. You can edit these
files with an ASCII editor (e.g. Notepad/
Editor in Windows Accessories) and
load them onto any handset. You can
also transfer directory entries to your
PC address book (e.g. Outlook
Express™ address book).
u Transfer contact details from your PC
address book to handset directories.
Export the contacts, e.g. with Outlook
Express™ to vcf files (vCards) and transfer them to handset directories using
the Web configurator.
u Delete the directory on the handset.
If you have edited the directory file
(vcf file) on the PC and would like to
use this modified directory on the
handset, you can delete the current
directory from the handset first.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / web_server.fm / 27.10.08
Web configurator –configuring phone via PC
Tip: Back up the current directory on
your PC before deleting it. You can then
load it back onto the handset if the
modified directory is affected by formatting errors and some, or all, of it
cannot be loaded onto the handset.
Please note:
– You can find information on the vCard format (vcf) on the Internet, e.g. under:
www.en.wikipedia.org/wiki/VCard or
www.de.wikipedia.org/wiki/VCard
(You can set the display language at the
bottom left-hand side in the navigation
area of the Web page.)
– You can still load directories in tsv format
from your PC to your handset.
– If you want to transfer a handset directory
(vcf file) saved on the PC that contains
numerous entries to a Microsoft Outlook™
address book, please note the following:
Microsoft Outlook™ only ever transfers the
first (directory) entry from the vcf file to its
address book.
Preconditions:
The display will show how many of the
entries from the vcf file are being transferred to the directory.
Transfer rules
The directory entries from a vcf file that
are loaded onto the handset will be added
to the directory. If an entry already exists
for a name, it will either be supplemented
or a new entry for the name created. The
process will not overwrite or delete any
phone numbers.
Please note:
Depending on your handset type, up to
3 entries with the same name will be created
in the handset directory for each vCard – one
entry per entered number.
Loading the directory from the
handset to the PC
¤ In the Handset Directory area, click Save.
A Windows dialogue will be shown to
save the file.
Enter the directory on the PC (complete
path name) in which the directory file is
to be stored. Click Save or OK.
u The handset can send and receive
¤
¤ Open the following Web page:
Settings ¢ Handsets.
Deleting the directory
directory entries.
u The handset is activated and is in idle
status.
The names of all registered handsets are
displayed in the Directory area.
¤ Select the handset for which you want
to save or edit the directory. To do this,
click on the option before the handset.
Loading the directory file from the PC
to the handset
¤ In the Transfer directory to handset area,
¤
enter the vcf file you want to load onto
the handset (complete path name), or
click Browse... and navigate your way to
the file.
Click the Transfer button to start the
transfer.
¤ In the Handset Directory area, click
Delete.
¤ Confirm the security prompt Telephone
directory of the selected handset will be
deleted. Continue? with OK.
This deletes all the entries in the directory,
including the entries for online directories.
Please note:
For how to delete the directory on the handset,
see page 43.
131
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / web_server.fm / 27.10.08
Web configurator –configuring phone via PC
Directory content (vcf file)
The following data (if available) is written
into the vcf file for entry into the directory
or transferred from a vcf file into the handset directory.
1. Name
2. First name
3. Number
4. Number (office)
5. Number (mobile)
6. E-mail address
7. Date (YYYY-MM-DD) and time of the reminder call (HH:MM) separated by a "T"
(example: 2008-01-22T11:00).
8. Identification as VIP (X-SIEMENS-VIP:1)
Other information that a vCard may contain is not entered into the handset directory.
Example for an entry in vCard format:
BEGIN:VCARD
VERSION:2.1
N:Smith;Anna
TEL;HOME:1234567890
TEL;WORK:0299123456
TEL;CELL:0175987654321
EMAIL:anna@smith.com
BDAY:1975-05-04T11:00
X-SIEMENS-VIP:1
END:VCARD
132
Activating VoIP status message
display
You can display VoIP status messages on
your handset when there are VoIP connection problems. These messages give you
information on the status of a connection
and contain a provider-specific status
code that helps the service team when
they are analysing the problem.
¤ Open the following Web page:
Settings ¢ Handsets.
¤
¤
The settings are carried out in the
Miscellaneous area.
Click the Yes option next to Show VoIP
status on handset to activate the status
message display.
If you click No, no VoIP status messages
are displayed.
Click Set to save the changes.
Please note:
A table with possible status codes and their
meaning can be found in the appendix on
page 140.
Starting a firmware update
If necessary, you can load updates of the
base station firmware onto your phone.
The server on which Gigaset Communications makes new firmware versions available for your base station is set by default.
The URL of the Internet server is displayed
in the Data server field.
You should only change this URL under
exceptional circumstances (e.g. if
requested to do so due to erroneous
behaviour). This address is also used to
load provider information from the Internet. You should therefore make a note of
the default URL before you overwrite it.
Otherwise, you will only be able to reactivate the default URL by resetting the base
station back to the default settings
(page 96).
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / web_server.fm / 27.10.08
Web configurator –configuring phone via PC
Please note:
– When updating from the Internet, checks
are made to ensure that no newer version
of the firmware exists. If this is not the case,
the operation is terminated.
– The firmware is only loaded from the Internet if you have not entered a local file in the
User defined firmware file field prior to the
update.
Preconditions:
u No calls are being made via the fixed
line network or VoIP.
u There is no internal connection
This setting is automatically used for this
particular firmware update. The URL in
the Data server field is saved and used
again for subsequent firmware updates.
You will have to re-enter the IP address
and file name if you need to carry out
another firmware update on your local PC.
Please note:
If an error arises during a firmware update from
a local PC, the most recent version of the
firmware is automatically downloaded from
the Internet.
between registered handsets.
u The base station menu is not open in
any of the handsets.
Activating/deactivating the
automatic version check
¤ Open the following Web page: Settings
¢ Miscellaneous.
¤ Click Update Firmware.
When the version check is activated, the
phone checks on a daily basis whether the
Gigaset configuration server is carrying a
new version of the phone firmware or of
the file with the general settings for your
VoIP provider.
If a new version is available, a notification
is sent to the handset and the message key
flashes. You can then carry out an automatic update of the firmware (page 99) or
of the VoIP provider settings (page 100).
The firmware is updated. This process can
take up to 3 minutes.
Please note:
You can also start the firmware update on the
handset (page 98).
Firmware update from local firmware file
In exceptional circumstances you may
receive, for example, a firmware file from
Service that you can upload from your PC
to your telephone (e.g. because the
firmware update via the Internet did not
work).
Precondition: A Web server is running on
the local PC (e.g. Apache).
¤ First load the firmware file onto your
¤ Open the following Web page:
Settings ¢ Miscellaneous.
¤ Click the Yes option next to Automatic
¤
check for software/profile updates to activate the automatic version check.
Click No if you do not want a version
check to be carried out.
Click Set to save the changes.
PC.
¤ In the User defined firmware file field
¤
¤
enter the IP address of the PC in your
local network and then complete the
path and name of the firmware file on
the PC. Example: 192.168.2.105/
C470IP/FW_file.bin.
Click Set to save the changes.
Click the Update Firmware button to start
the update.
133
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / web_server.fm / 27.10.08
Web configurator –configuring phone via PC
Copying the date/time from
time server
The date and time are shown in the idle
display of registered handsets. They are
important, for example, for stating the
correct time in the calls list and for the
"anniversary", "appointment" and "alarm
clock" functions.
There are two methods for updating the
time and date on your base station: manually with one of the registered handsets
(page 11) or automatically by synchronisation with a time server on the Internet.
Activate/deactivate synchronisation with a
time server as follows:
¤ Open the following Web page:
Settings ¢ Miscellaneous.
¤ In the Automatic adjustment of System
Time with Time Server field select Yes to
activate synchronisation between base
station and a time server. If you select
No the base station will not adopt time
settings from a time server. In this case
you should set the time and date manually using a handset.
¤ The Last synchronisation with time server
¤
¤
¤
field shows the last time when the base
station compared time and date settings with a time server.
In the Time Server field, enter the Internet address or name of the time server
from which the base station should
adopt its time and date settings. The
time server "europe.pool.ntp.org" is set
as default on the base station. You can
overwrite the setting.
From the Country list, select the country
in which your base station is being
operated.
The Time Zone field shows the valid time
zone for the Country. It shows the deviation between local time (not summer
time) and Greenwich Mean Time
(GMT).
134
¤
¤
If a country is divided into various time
zones, they will all appear in the list.
Select the appropriate Time Zone for the
base station from the list.
The Automatically adjust clock to summertime changes field will be displayed if
your time zone differentiates between
summer time and winter time.
Activate On if you want the time to
change automatically to summer time
or winter time when summer time
begins and ends respectively.
Activate Off if you do not want to
change to summer time.
Please note: If the date and time are
updated by a time server that automatically switches between summer time
and standard time, you must always
activate Off here.
Click the Set button to save the settings
in your phone.
Once you have activated synchronisation
the base station will compare time and
date with a time server as soon as an internet connection is established.
Synchronisation will usually occur once a
day (at night) if synchronisation is activated. Any additional synchronisation will
take place only after each new system
start of the base station (e.g. after a
firmware update or a power cut).
If you register a new handset on your base
station it will assume the time and date of
the base station without any additional
synchronisation with the time server.
Date and time settings are transferred to
every handset after synchronisation.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / web_server.fm / 27.10.08
Web configurator –configuring phone via PC
Please note:
– The default time server
"europe.pool.ntp.org" will remain stored in
the base station even if you overwrite it. If
you delete your time server from the Time
Server field and synchronisation is still activated, the base station will return to synchronisation with the default time server.
However, it will no longer appear in
the Time Server field.
– The base station will return to synchronisation with the default time server if you have
entered your own time server in the Time
Server field and the base station is unable to
synchronise time and date for ten consecutive attempts.
– If you have deactivated synchronisation
with a time server, and if the date and time
are not set on any handset, then the base
station will attempt to reference date and
time settings from the CLIP information of
an incoming call.
Querying the phone status
General information about your phone is
displayed.
¤ In the menu list, click the Status tab.
The following information is displayed:
IP Configuration
IP address
The phone's current IP address within
the local network. For assigning the IP
address, see page 109.
MAC address
The phone's device address.
Software
Firmware version
Version of the firmware currently
downloaded. You can download
updates of the firmware on your phone
(page 98). Firmware updates are available on the Internet.
EEPROM version
Version of your phone's EEPROM storage chip (page 162).
135
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / appendix.fm / 27.10.08
Appendix
Appendix
Please note:
Care
Wipe the base station, charging cradle and
handset with a damp cloth (do not use
solvent) or an antistatic cloth.
Never use a dry cloth. This can cause
static.
Contact with liquid
!
If the handset has come into contact with
liquid:
1. Switch off the handset and remove
the battery pack immediately.
2. Allow the liquid to drain from the handset.
3. Pat all parts dry, then place the handset
with the battery compartment open
and the keypad facing down in a dry,
warm place for at least 72 hours (not
in a microwave, oven etc.).
4. Do not switch on the handset again
until it is completely dry.
When it has fully dried out, you will normally be able to use it again.
Questions and answers
If you have any questions about using
your phone, visit us at www.gigaset.com/
customercare at any time. The table below
contains a list of common problems and
possible solutions.
To support the service team, it can be helpful if
you have the following information to hand:
– Version of firmware, EEPROM and your
phone's MAC address
You can check this information with the
Web configurator (page 135). For how to
display the MAC address on your handset,
turn to page 102.
– VoIP status code (page 140)
For problems with VoIP connections, you
should set VoIP status messages to be displayed on your handset (page 100,
page 132). These messages contain a status code that helps when the problem is
analysed.
Registration or connection problems with a
Bluetooth headset.
¥
¥
¥
Reset the Bluetooth headset (see the user
guide for your headset).
Delete registration data from the handset
when de-registering the device
(see page 94).
Repeat the registration process
(see page 94).
The display is blank.
1. The handset is not switched on.
Press and hold the end call key .
¥
2. The battery is flat.
Charge the battery or replace it
(page 10).
¥
The keys of a handset do not respond when
pressed.
The keypad lock is activated.
Press and hold the hash key (page 31).
¥
"Base X" flashes on the display.
1. The handset is outside the range of the
base station.
Move the handset closer to the base
station.
¥
2. The handset has been de-registered.
Register the handset (page 81).
¥
3. The base station is not turned on.
Check the base station's mains adapter
(page 13).
Version 4, 16.09.2005
¥
4. The base station firmware is currently being
updated (page 98/page 132).
Please wait until the update is complete.
¥
136
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / appendix.fm / 27.10.08
Appendix
"Base Search" flashes in the display.
The handset is set to Best Base and no base station is turned on or within range.
Move the handset closer to the base station.
Check the base station mains adapter.
¥
¥
Handset does not ring.
1. The ringer tone is switched off.
Activate the ringer tone (page 89).
¥
2. Call forwarding set to All Calls.
Deactivate call forwarding (fixed line
network page 37; VoIP page 39/
page 121).
¥
You cannot hear a ringer/dialling tone from
the fixed line network.
Base station's phone cord has been replaced.
When purchasing a new cord, ensure that it
has the correct jack pin connections
(page 14).
¥
Error tone sounds after system PIN prompt.
You have entered the wrong system PIN.
Enter system PIN if required.
Have you forgotten the system PIN?
Carry out a reset on the base station to set
the system PIN back to 0000 (page 97).
¥
¥
The other party cannot hear you.
You have pressed the (INT) key. The handset is "muted".
Activate the microphone again (page 31).
¥
When making calls from the fixed line network, the caller's phone number is not displayed although CLIP (page 29) is set.
Calling Line Identification is not enabled.
The caller should ask his network provider
to enable Calling Line Identification (CLI).
¥
You hear an error tone (descending tone
sequence) when inputting.
Action has failed/invalid input.
Repeat the operation.
Watch the display and refer to the user
guide if necessary.
Version 4, 16.09.2005
¥
You cannot connect to the router and the
phone is assigned a static IP address.
¥
¥
Check on the router whether the IP address
is already being used by another device in
the LAN or belongs to the block of IP
addresses that is reserved on the router for
dynamic address assignment.
If necessary, change the phone's IP address
(page 101).
You have made a call via VoIP but cannot
hear the other caller.
Your phone is connected to a router with NAT/
firewall.
Your STUN server (page 115) or outbound
proxy (page 115) settings are incomplete or
incorrect. Check the settings.
No outbound proxy is entered or the outbound proxy mode Never is activated
(page 115) and your phone is connected to
a router with symmetric NAT or a blocking
firewall.
Port forwarding is activated on your router,
but no permanent IP address has been
assigned to your phone.
¥
¥
¥
You cannot make calls via VoIP. "Server not
accessible!" is displayed.
¥
First wait a few minutes. This is often a
short-term event that corrects itself after a
short time.
If the message is still displayed, proceed as follows:
Check whether your phone's Ethernet cable
is correctly connected to the router.
Check your router's cable connection to the
Internet.
Check whether the phone is connected to
the LAN. Send a ping command, e.g. from
your PC, to the phone (ping s <local IP
address of the phone>). It may be that no IP
address could be assigned to the phone or
a permanently set IP address is already
assigned to another LAN subscriber. Check
the settings on the router, you may have to
activate the DHCP server.
¥
¥
¥
137
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / appendix.fm / 27.10.08
Appendix
You cannot make calls via VoIP. Either "Provider registration failed!" or "Registration failed" is
shown.
First wait a few minutes. This is often a
short-term event that corrects itself after a
short time.
The message may still be displayed for the following reasons:
¥
1. The personal VoIP access data (Username,
Authent. Name and Authent. Password) you
have entered may be incomplete or wrong.
Check your information. In particular,
check your use of upper and lower case.
¥
2. The general settings for your VoIP provider
are incomplete or incorrect (incorrect
server address).
Start the Web configurator and check
the settings.
¥
You cannot make calls via VoIP. The display
shows IP configuration error: xxx or VoIP config.error: xxx (xxx = VoIP status code).
You are trying to make a call via a VoIP connection that is not properly configured.
Start the Web configurator and check the
settings. Possible status codes and their
meanings are listed on page 140.
¥
The phone does not dial an entered number.
The display shows Not possible!.
The number may be blocked (dial rule).
Open the Dialling Plans Web page of the
Web configurator and delete or deactivate
the block if necessary.
¥
You cannot establish a connection to the
phone with your PC's Web browser.
¥
¥
¥
Version 4, 16.09.2005
¥
138
When establishing a connection, check the
phone's local IP address that has been
entered. You can check the IP address on
your handset.
Check the LAN connections for the PC and
phone.
Check that your phone can be reached.
Send a ping command, e.g. from your PC,
to the phone (ping s <local IP address of
the phone>).
You have tried to reach the phone via a
secure http (https://...). Try again with
http://....
You cannot be reached for calls from the
Internet.
¥
¥
¥
There is no entry for your phone in your
router's routing table. Check the settings
for the NAT refresh time (page 115).
Your phone is not registered with the VoIP
provider.
You have entered the wrong user ID or an
incorrect domain (page 113).
No firmware update or VoIP profile download is carried out.
1. If Currently not possible! is displayed, the VoIP
connections may be busy or a download/
update is already being carried out.
Repeat the process at a later time.
¥
2. If File corrupted! is displayed, the firmware or
profile file may be invalid.
Please only use firmware and downloads that are made available on the preconfigured Gigaset configuration server
(page 132) or at
www.gigaset.com/customercare.
¥
3. If Server not accessible! is displayed, the
download server may not be accessible.
The server is currently not accessible.
Repeat the process at a later time.
You have changed the preconfigured
server address (page 132). Correct the
address. If necessary, reset the base station.
¥
¥
4. If Transmission Error XXX is displayed, an
error has occurred in the transmission of
the file. An HTTP error code is displayed for
XXX.
Repeat the process. If the error occurs
again, consult the Service department.
¥
5. If Check IP settings! is displayed, your phone
may not be connected to the Internet.
Check the cable connections between
the phone and router and between the
router and the Internet.
Check whether the phone is connected
to the LAN, i.e. it can be reached at its IP
address.
¥
¥
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / appendix.fm / 27.10.08
Appendix
You cannot listen to or control a network
mailbox.
VoIP:
Your VoIP provider does not support the type of
DTMF signalling set up on your phone.
Ask your VoIP provider which signalling it
supports and change the settings on your
phone (page 122) if necessary.
Operating the base station within a PABX:
Your PABX is set for dial pulsing.
Set your PABX to touch tone dialling.
¥
The integrated answer machine will not
record a conversation or interrupts the twoway recording.
1. An error tone sounds and the display shows
Not possible!.
¥
¥
No time is specified for a message in the call
history.
Date/time is not set.
Set date/time (page 11) or
Activate base station synchronisation
with a time server on the Internet
(page 134).
¥
¥
The integrated answer machine reports
"Invalid PIN" on remote operation.
1. You have entered the wrong system PIN.
Enter the system PIN again.
¥
You are making the call via a broadband
VoIP connection. A recording is not possible in this case. The attempt by the
base station to establish a non-broadband connection instead has failed
(rearranging the codec).
If necessary, you or the other caller must
change the setting for the codec used
(page 117).
2. The display shows Delete messages
The answer machine's memory is full.
Use a different handset to delete messages from the answer machine and
restart two-way recording.
Or:
Finish the call, delete old messages from
the answer machine and re-establish
the connection.
¥
¥
2. The system PIN is still set to 0000.
Change the system PIN (page 96).
¥
The integrated answer machine does not
record messages/has switched to notification announcement.
Its memory is full.
Delete old messages.
Play back new messages and delete.
Version 4, 16.09.2005
¥
¥
139
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / appendix.fm / 27.10.08
Appendix
VoIP status codes
If you have problems with your VoIP connections, activate the Show Stat. on HS
function (page 100, page 132). You will
then receive a VoIP status code that will
support you in problem analysis. Also
enter the code during problem analysis by
the Service department.
In the following tables you will find the
meanings of the most important status
codes and messages.
Status
code
Meaning
0x31
IP configuration error:
IP domain not entered.
0x33
IP configuration error:
SIP user name (Authentication Name)
not entered.
This is shown, for example, when
dialling with a line suffix, if no connection is configured for the suffix on
the base station.
0x34
IP configuration error:
SIP password (Authentication password) not entered.
0x300
0x301
Version 4, 16.09.2005
0x302
140
The called party can be reached
under several phone numbers. If the
VoIP provider supports this, a list of
the phone numbers is transmitted as
well as the status code. The caller can
select to which number he wants to
make the connection.
Permanently redirected.
The called party can no longer be
reached under this number. The new
number is transmitted to the phone
together with the status code, and
the phone then no longer accesses
the old number but dials the new
address immediately.
Temporarily redirected.
The phone is informed that the called
party cannot be reached under the
number dialled. The duration of redirecting is time-limited. The phone is
also notified of the duration of redirecting.
Status
code
Meaning
0x305
The query is sent to a different "proxy
server", e.g. to balance out incoming
queries. The phone will make the
same query once again to another
proxy server. This is not a redirection
of the address per se.
0x380
Other service:
The query or the call could not be
made. But the phone is notified what
other options there are to be able to
connect the call.
0x400
Wrong call
0x401
Not authorised
0x403
The requested service is not supported by the VoIP provider.
0x404
Wrong phone number.
No caller on this number.
Example: In a local call you have not
dialled the area code although your
VoIP provider does not support local
calls.
0x405
Method not permitted.
0x406
Not acceptable.
The requested service cannot be provided.
0x407
Proxy authentication required.
0x408
The party cannot be reached (e.g.
account has been deleted).
0x410
The requested service is not available
from the VoIP provider.
0x413
Message is too long.
0x414
URI is too long.
0x415
Query format is not supported.
0x416
URI is faulty.
0x420
Incorrect ending
0x421
Incorrect ending
0x423
The requested service is not supported by the VoIP provider.
0x480
The dialled number is temporarily
unavailable.
0x481
The recipient is not available.
0x482
Double service query
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / appendix.fm / 27.10.08
Appendix
Status
code
Meaning
Status
code
Meaning
0x483
Too many "hops":
The query was rejected because the
service server (proxy) has decided
that this query has already passed
through too many service servers.
The maximum number was previously specified by the original sender
of the query.
0x501
0x484
Wrong number:
In most cases this response means
that you have simply omitted one or
more digits in the phone number.
The query cannot be processed by
the recipient because the recipient
does not have the functionality that
the caller requires. If the recipient
understands the query but does not
process it because the sender does
not have the necessary rights or the
query is not permitted in the current
context, a 405 is sent instead of 501.
0x502
0x485
The URI dialled is not unique and cannot be processed by the VoIP provider.
In this case, the receiving device that
transmits this error code is a proxy or
a gateway and has received an invalid
response from its gateway via which
this query is to be processed.
0x503
The query cannot currently be processed by the receiving device or the
proxy because the server is either
overloaded or is being serviced. If it is
possible for the query to be repeated
in the foreseeable future, the server
informs the caller or the phone of
this.
0x504
Time limit at the gateway
0x505
The server rejects the query because
the indicated version number of the
SIP protocol does not at least concur
with the version that is used by server
or the SIP device involved in this
query.
0x515
The server rejects the query because
the message exceeds the maximum
permitted size.
0x600
The called party is busy.
0x486
The called party is busy.
0x487
General faults:
The call was interrupted before a call
was established. The status code confirms receipt of the interruption signal.
0x488
The server cannot process the query
because the data entered in the
media description is not compatible.
0x491
The server notifies that the query will
be processed as soon as a previous
query has been completed.
0x493
The server rejects the query because
the phone cannot decrypt the message. The sender has used an encryption method that neither the server
nor the receiver phone can decrypt.
Version 4, 16.09.2005
0x500
The proxy or the receiving device has
discovered a fault while executing
the query, which makes further execution of the query impossible. In this
case, the caller or the phone displays
the fault and repeats the query after
a few seconds. The number of seconds after which the query can be
repeated may be transmitted to the
caller or phone by the receiving
device.
0x603
The called party has rejected the call.
0x604
The called URI does not exist.
0x606
The communication settings are not
acceptable.
0x701
The called party has hung up.
0x703
Connection interrupted because of
time-out.
0x704
Connection interrupted because of a
SIP error.
0x705
Wrong dialling tone
0x706
No connection established
141
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / appendix.fm / 27.10.08
Appendix
Status
code
Meaning
Checking service information
0x751
Busy tone:
No codec match between the calling
and called party.
You may need the service information of
your phone (base station and handset) for
Customer Services.
0x810
General socket layer error: User is not
authorised.
Base station service information
0x811
General socket layer error:
Wrong socket number
0x812
General socket layer error: Socket is
not connected.
0x813
General socket layer error:
Memory error
0x814
General socket layer error: Socket not
available – check IP settings/connection problem/VoIP setting incorrect.
0x815
General socket layer error:
Illegal application on the socket interface.
Precondition: You are conducting an
external call. The connection has been
established for at least 8 sec.
§Options§ ¢ Service Info
Confirm selection with §OK§.
The following information is displayed:
1: Serial number of the base station (RFPI)
2: Serial number of your handset (IPUI)
3: Informs the service employees of the
base station settings (in hex diagram),
e.g. the number of registered handsets,
repeater mode. The last 4 digits indicate
the number of operating hours (hexadecimal).
4: Variant, version of the firmware (digits 3
to 5).
5: Gigaset.net number of your phone.
With this number you can call a service
employee over the Internet without needing to be registered with a VoIP provider.
This means that the employee can test
online connections and VoIP telephony
irrespective of the VoIP provider.
Service information of the handset
In the handset idle status:
Open the menu by pressing v
¤ Press the following keys one after the
other: QL
Version 4, 16.09.2005
The following information, among other
details, is displayed on the handset:
1: Serial number (IPUI)
2: Number of operating hours
3: Variant, version of handset software
142
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / appendix.fm / 27.10.08
Appendix
Service (Customer Care)
Authorisation
We offer you support that is fast and tailored to your specific needs!
Our Online Support on the Internet can be
reached any time from anywhere.
www.gigaset.com/customercare
It provides you with 24/7 support for all
our products. It also provides a list of FAQs
and answers plus user guides and current
software updates (if available for the product) for you to download.
You will also find frequently asked questions and answers in the appendix of this
user guide.
For personal advice on our range of products and assistance with repairs or guarantee/warranty claims you can contact us
on:
UK helpdesk: 0 84 53 67 08 12.
Please have your proof of purchase ready
when calling with regard to guarantee/
warranty claims.
Replacement or repair services are not
offered in countries where our product is
not sold by authorised dealers.
This device is intended for analogue
phone lines in the UK.
Voice over IP telephony is possible via the
LAN interface if an additonal modem has
been connected.
Country-specific requirements have been
taken into consideration.
We, Gigaset Communications GmbH,
declare that this device meets the
essential requirements and other relevant
regulations laid down in Directive 1999/5/
EC.
A copy of the 1999/5/EC Declaration of
Conformity is available at this Internet
address:
www.gigaset.com/docs.
Bluetooth Qualified Design Identity
The Bluetooth QD ID for your Gigaset S68H
is: B012741.
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Please address any questions about DSL
access and VoIP access to the respective
service provider.
143
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / appendix.fm / 27.10.08
Appendix
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Guarantee Certificate
United Kingdom
Without prejudice to any claim the user
(customer) may have in relation to the
dealer or retailer, the customer shall be
granted a manufacturer's Guarantee
under the conditions set out below:
u In the case of new devices and their
components exhibiting defects resulting from manufacturing and/or material faults within 24 months of purchase, Gigaset Communications shall,
at its own option and free of charge,
either replace the device with another
device reflecting the current state of
the art, or repair the said device. In
respect of parts subject to wear and
tear (including but not limited to, batteries, keypads, casing), this warranty
shall be valid for six months from the
date of purchase.
u This Guarantee shall be invalid if the
device defect is attributable to
improper treatment and/or failure to
comply with information contained in
the user guides.
u This Guarantee shall not apply to or
extend to services performed by the
authorised dealer or the customer
themselves (e. g. installation, configuration, software downloads). User
guides and any software supplied on a
separate data medium shall be
excluded from the Guarantee.
u The purchase receipt, together with the
date of purchase, shall be required as
evidence for invoking the Guarantee.
Claims under the Guarantee must be
submitted within two months of the
Guarantee default becoming evident.
u Ownership of devices or components
replaced by and returned to Gigaset
Communications shall vest in Gigaset
Communications.
u This Guarantee shall apply to new
devices purchased in the European
Union. For Products sold in the United
144
Kingdom the Guarantee is issued by:
Gigaset Communications GmbH, Schlavenhorst 66, D-46395 Bocholt, Germany.
u Any other claims resulting out of or in
connection with the device shall be
excluded from this Guarantee. Nothing
in this Guarantee shall attempt to limit
or exclude a Customers Statutory
Rights, nor the manufacturer's liability
for death or personal injury resulting
from its negligence.
u The duration of the Guarantee shall not
be extended by services rendered
under the terms of the Guarantee.
u Insofar as no Guarantee default exists,
Gigaset Communications reserves the
right to charge the customer for
replacement or repair.
u The above provisions does not imply a
change in the burden of proof to the
detriment of the customer.
To invoke this Guarantee, please contact
the Gigaset Communications telephone
service. The relevant number is to be
found in the accompanying user guide.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / appendix.fm / 27.10.08
Appendix
Specifications
Recommended batteries
Technology:
Nickel-metal-hydride (NiMH)
Size:
AAA (Micro, HR03)
Voltage: 1.2 V
Capacity: 600 – 1200 mAh
We recommend the following battery
types, because these are the only ones
that guarantee the specified operating
times, full functionality and long service
life:
u Sanyo NiMH 800
u GP 850 mAh
u Yuasa Technologies AAA 800
The device is supplied with two recommended batteries.
Handset operating times/charging
times
The operating time of your Gigaset
depends on the capacity and age of the
batteries and the way they are used. (All
times are maximum possible times and
apply when the display backlight is
switched off).
Capacity (mAh)
600
800
1000 1200
130
175
220
265
Talktime (hours)
7
10
12
14
Operating time for
1.5 hrs of calls per
day (hours)
70
90
115
135
Charging time,
base station
(hours)
6
9
11
13
Charging time,
charging cradle
(hours)
5
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Standby time
(hours)
7
8
10
At the time of going to print, batteries up
to 900 mAh were available and had been
tested in the system. Due to the constant
progression in battery development, the
list of recommended batteries in the FAQ
section of the Gigaset Customer Care
pages is regularly updated:
www.gigaset.com/customercare
Base station power consumption
The power consumption for the base station is approx. 1.3 watt.
General specifications
Interfaces
Fixed line network,
Ethernet
No. of channels
60 duplex channels
Radio frequency
range
1880 – 1900 MHz
Duplex method
Time multiplex,
10 ms frame length
Channel grid
1728 kHz
Bit rate
1152 kbit/s
Modulation
GFSK
Language code
32 kbit/s
Transmission
power
10 mW, average power
per channel
Range
up to 300 m outdoors,
up to 50 m indoors
Base station power
supply
230 V ~/50 Hz
Environmental
conditions in
operation
+5°C to +45°C;
20% to 75% relative
humidity
Codecs
G.711, G.726, G.729AB
with VAD/CNG, G.722
Quality of Service
TOS, DiffServ
Protocols
DECT, GAP, SIP, RTP, DHCP,
NAT Traversal (STUN),
HTTP
145
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / appendix.fm / 27.10.08
Appendix
Icons
This section explains the meaning of certain icons and typographical conventions
that are used in this user guide.
Copy Entry / Copy List (example)
Select one of the two specified
menu functions.
Enter digits or letters.
§Save§
The display keys' current functions are shown reverse highlighted in the bottom display
line. Press the display key
below to launch the function.
Press the control key at the top
or bottom: scroll up or down.
Press the control key on the
right or left: e.g. select setting.
/ Q / etc.
Press the matching key on the
handset.
Example of a menu input
The steps you need to perform are shown
in abbreviated form in the user guide. This
is illustrated below using the example of
"Setting the contrast for the display". The
things you have to do are explained in the
boxes.
v¢
¢ Display
¤ With the handset in idle status, press
on the right of the control key to open
the main menu.
¤ Use the control key to select the icon
(Settings ) – to do this, press up,
down, right and left / on the
control key until the icon has been
selected.
Settings appears in the display header.
¤ Press the display key §OK§ to confirm the
selection.
The Settings submenu is displayed.
¤ Press up or down on the control key
repeatedly until the Display menu function is selected.
¤ Press the display key §OK§ to confirm the
selection.
Contrast
Select and press §OK§.
¤ Press down on the control key repeat¤
edly until the Contrast menu function is
selected.
Press the display key §OK§ or on the right
of the control key to confirm your
selection.
Select contrast.
¤ Press on the right or left of the control
key to set the contrast.
§Save§
Press the display key.
¤ Press the display key §Save§ or on the
right of the control key to save the setting.
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Press and hold (idle status).
¤ Press and hold the end call key until the
handset returns to idle status.
146
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / appendix.fm / 27.10.08
Appendix
Example of multiple line input
In many situations you can change settings or enter data in several lines of a display.
In this user guide, icons are used to guide
you step by step through multiple line
input. This is illustrated below using the
example of "Setting the date and time".
The things you have to do are explained in
the boxes.
To change the time, open the input field
with:
v ¢ ¢ Date/Time
You will see the following in the display
(example):
Date/Time
Date:
[15.01.2008]
Time:
11:11
7
Save
Date:
Enter the day, month and year in 8digit format.
The second line is marked with [ ] to
show it is active.
¤ Enter the date using the digit keys.
¤ Save the changes.
¤ Press the display key §Save§.
¤ Then press and hold the key. The
handset switches to idle status.
Or:
¤ Press the display key §Options§.
¤ Select Save and then press the display
key §OK§.
¤ Then press and hold the key. The
handset switches to idle status.
Writing and editing text
The following rules apply when writing
text:
u Control the cursor with v .
u Characters are inserted to the left of
the cursor.
u Press the star key to display the
table of special characters (see below
"Entering special characters".)
u The first letter of the name of directory
entries is automatically capitalised, followed by lower case letters.
Entering special characters
¤ Press the star key .
A table is opened containing all the
special characters. The cursor is positioned on the character " . "(full stop).
Time:
Enter hours/minutes in 4-digit format.
¤ Press the key.
The fourth line is marked with [ ] to show
it is active.
¤ Enter the date using the digit keys.
_
!
?
@
,
’
"
¤
(
)
;
:
§.§
-
+
&
%
*
=
<
>
/
â
£
$
¥
[
]
§
\
~
^
¿
¡
{
}
#
|
¤ Navigate to the required character with
¤
Version 4, 16.09.2005
s
the control key , . Example: to
select * press 4 x and 1 x .
Press the display key §Insert§. The
character is inserted into the text.
Pressing again closes the table
without inserting a character.
147
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / appendix.fm / 27.10.08
Appendix
Writing a text/name (without predictive
text)
Writing a text/name (with predictive
text)
Press the relevant key several times to
enter letters/characters.
The EATONI predictive text function helps
you when you are writing messenger messages and SMS.
Each key between Q and O is
assigned several letters and characters
(see special characters, page 147). These
appear in a selection line immediately
under the text panel (over the display
keys) as soon as you press a key. The letter
you are most likely looking for is shown in
reversed highlights and is at the beginning of the selection line. It is copied into
the text panel.
Standard characters
1x
3
L
M
N
O
Q
2x
2)
1)
a
d
g
j
m
p
t
w
.
b
e
h
k
n
q
u
x
,
3x
4x
5x
6x
7x
8x
9x 10x
1
c
f
i
l
o
r
v
y
?
2
3
4
5
6
s
8
z
!
ä
ë
ï
á
é
í
à
è
ì
â
ê
î
ã
ç
ö
7
ü
9
0
ñ
ß
ú
ÿ
ó
ò
ô
õ
ù
ý
û
æ
ø
å
1) Space
2) Line break
When you press and hold a key, the characters of the corresponding key are displayed in the bottom display line and
marked one after another. When you
release the key the highlighted character
is inserted into the input field.
Setting upper/lower case or digits
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Press and hold the hash key before
entering the character to switch from
"Abc" mode to "123", from "123" to "abc"
and from "abc" to "Abc" (upper case:
1st letter upper case, all others lower
case).
The display shows whether upper case,
lower case or digits is selected. The bottom right of the display (above the right
display key) shows "Abc", "abc" or "123".
148
Messenger
Hello Peter, I cannot come
today. W
hgi
X
1
2
3
4
8 Abc
1
2
3
4
Options
SMS text
Selection line
EATONI is activated
Upper/lower case or digits
If this letter is the one you want, confirm it
by pressing the next key. If it does not
match the one you want, press the hash
key briefly until the letter you are
looking for is reverse highlighted in the
display line and then transferred to the
text field.
If you press and hold the hash key you switch from "Abc" mode to "123" and
from "123" to "abc" and from "abc" to
"Abc".
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / appendix.fm / 27.10.08
Appendix
Deactivating/activating predictive text
¤ You are writing an SMS (page 54) or a
Messenger message (page 76).
§Options§ / ©
Press the display key.
Predictive Text
Select and press §OK§ ( ‰ = on).
Press the end call key briefly
to return to the text field.
Enter the text.
Setting input language
¤ You are writing an SMS (page 54) or a
Messenger message (page 76).
§Options§ / ©
Press the display key.
Select Language
Select and press §OK§.
Select input language and
press §OK§.
Press the end call key briefly
twice to return to the input
field.
The input language setting only applies to
the current message/SMS.
Additional functions via the
PC interface
You can connect your Gigaset S68H handset to your computer using Bluetooth
(page 93). The computer must be
equipped with a suitable dongle.
Your handset can communicate with the
computer using the Gigaset QuickSync
program (free download at
www.gigaset.com/gigasetS670).
You can
u access your handset's directory and
synchronise it with Outlook, or copy
contact details to the handset,
u download CLIP pictures (.bmp) from
the computer to the handset,
u download pictures (.bmp) for the
screensaver from the computer to the
handset.
During the transfer of data between handset and PC, you will see Data transfer in
progress on the display. During this time
the keypad is disabled, and incoming calls
will be ignored.
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Order of directory entries
Directory entries are generally sorted
alphabetically by surname. Spaces and
digits take first priority. If only the first
name was entered in the directory, this is
incorporated into the sort order instead of
the surname.
The sort order is as follows:
1. Space
2. Digits (0–9)
3. Letters (alphabetical)
4. Other characters
To get round the alphabetical order of the
entries, insert a space or a digit in front of
the first letter of the surname. These
entries will then move to the beginning of
the directory. Names that you have prefixed with a star will move to the end of
the directory.
149
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / appendix.fm / 27.10.08
Appendix
Gigaset S685/S675 IP –
free software
Your Gigaset S685/S675 IP's firmware
includes free software that is licensed
under the GNU Lesser General Public
License. This free software was developed
by a third party and is protected by copyright. You will find the licence text in its
original English version on the pages that
follow.
The software is provided free of charge.
You are authorised to use this free software in accordance with the above-mentioned licence conditions. In the event of
contradictions between these licence conditions and the licence conditions that
apply for the software according to
Gigaset Communications GmbH, the
above-mentioned licence conditions shall
take precedence for the free software.
Version 4, 16.09.2005
The GNU Lesser General Public License
(LGPL) is supplied with this product. You
can also download the licence conditions
from the Internet:
u The LGPL is available on the Internet at:
http://www.gnu.org/copyleft/
lesser.html
u The source text, including copyright
notices for free software, is currently
available on the Internet at:
http://www.gigaset.com/developer
For more information and Internet links to
the source text of the free software, see
the Online Support pages on the Internet
at:
www.gigaset.com/customercare
150
If it is not already supplied with the product, you can request the source text,
including copyright notices, from Gigaset
Communications GmbH. There is a charge
to cover the cost of copying and postage.
Please submit this request by e-mail or fax
to the following address or fax number
within 3 years of purchasing this product.
Please state the exact device type plus the
version number of the installed device
software.
Small Parts Dispatch Bocholt
E-mail: kleinteileversand.com@gigaset.com
Fax:
0049 2871 / 91 30 29
Use of the free software contained in this
product extending beyond the program
sequence intended by Gigaset Communications GmbH is at the user's own risk –
i.e. there shall be no claims for liability for
defects against Gigaset Communications
GmbH. The GNU Lesser General Public
License contains notes regarding the
author's liability for defects or that of
other proprietors of the free software.
You shall have no right to assert a claim
against Gigaset Communications GmbH
based on liability for defects, if a defect in
the product is or could be due to changes
you have made to the programs or their
configuration. Furthermore, you shall
have no right to assert a claim against
Gigaset Communications GmbH based on
liability for defects if the free software
infringes the copyright of third parties.
Gigaset Communications GmbH shall not
provide technical support for the software, including the free software included
within it, if it has been changed.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / appendix.fm / 27.10.08
Appendix
GNU LESSER GENERAL PUBLIC
LICENSE
Version 2.1, February 1999
Copyright (C) 1991, 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA
Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute
verbatim copies of this license document, but
changing it is not allowed.
[This is the first released version of the Lesser
GPL. It also counts as the successor of the GNU
Library Public License, version 2, hence the version number 2.1.]
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Preamble
The licenses for most software are designed to
take away your freedom to share and change it.
By contrast, the GNU General Public Licenses
are intended to guarantee your freedom to
share and change free software--to make sure
the software is free for all its users.
This license, the Lesser General Public License,
applies to some specially designated software
packages--typically libraries--of the Free Software Foundation and other authors who decide
to use it. You can use it too, but we suggest you
first think carefully about whether this license
or the ordinary General Public License is the
better strategy to use in any particular case,
based on the explanations below.
When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom of use, not price. Our General
Public Licenses are designed to make sure that
you have the freedom to distribute copies of
free software (and charge for this service if you
wish); that you receive source code or can get it
if you want it; that you can change the software
and use pieces of it in new free programs; and
that you are informed that you can do these
things.
To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions that forbid distributors to deny you these
rights or to ask you to surrender these rights.
These restrictions translate to certain responsibilities for you if you distribute copies of the
library or if you modify it.
For example, if you distribute copies of the
library, whether gratis or for a fee, you must
give the recipients all the rights that we gave
you. You must make sure that they, too, receive
or can get the source code. If you link other
code with the library, you must provide complete object files to the recipients, so that they
can relink them with the library after making
changes to the library and recompiling it. And
you must show them these terms so they know
their rights.
We protect your rights with a two-step method:
(1) we copyright the library, and (2) we offer
you this license, which gives you legal permission to copy, distribute and/or modify the
library.
To protect each distributor, we want to make it
very clear that there is no warranty for the free
library. Also, if the library is modified by someone else and passed on, the recipients should
know that what they have is not the original
version, so that the original author's reputation
will not be affected by problems that might be
introduced by others.
Finally, software patents pose a constant threat
to the existence of any free program. We wish
to make sure that a company cannot effectively
restrict the users of a free program by obtaining
a restrictive license from a patent holder. Therefore, we insist that any patent license obtained
for a version of the library must be consistent
with the full freedom of use specified in this
license.
Most GNU software, including some libraries, is
covered by the ordinary GNU General Public
License. This license, the GNU Lesser General
Public License, applies to certain designated
libraries, and is quite different from the ordinary General Public License. We use this license
for certain libraries in order to permit linking
those libraries into non-free programs.
When a program is linked with a library, whether statically or using a shared library, the
combination of the two is legally speaking a
combined work, a derivative of the original
library. The ordinary General Public License
therefore permits such linking only if the entire
combination fits its criteria of freedom. The Lesser General Public License permits more lax criteria for linking other code with the library.
We call this license the "Lesser" General Public
License because it does Less to protect the
user's freedom than the ordinary General Public
License. It also provides other free software
developers Less of an advantage over competing non-free programs. These disadvantages
are the reason we use the ordinary General
Public License for many libraries. However, the
Lesser license provides advantages in certain
special circumstances.
For example, on rare occasions, there may be a
special need to encourage the widest possible
use of a certain library, so that it becomes a defacto standard. To achieve this, non-free programs must be allowed to use the library. A
more frequent case is that a free library does
the same job as widely used non-free libraries.
In this case, there is little to gain by limiting the
151
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / appendix.fm / 27.10.08
Appendix
free library to free software only, so we use the
Lesser General Public License.
In other cases, permission to use a particular
library in non-free programs enables a greater
number of people to use a large body of free
software. For example, permission to use the
GNU C Library in non-free programs enables
many more people to use the whole GNU operating system, as well as its variant, the GNU/
Linux operating system.
Although the Lesser General Public License is
Less protective of the users' freedom, it does
ensure that the user of a program that is linked
with the Library has the freedom and the wherewithal to run that program using a modified
version of the Library.
The precise terms and conditions for copying,
distribution and modification follow. Pay close
attention to the difference between a "work
based on the library" and a "work that uses the
library". The former contains code derived from
the library, whereas the latter must be combined with the library in order to run.
Version 4, 16.09.2005
GNU LESSER GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION AND MODIFICATION
0. This License Agreement applies to any software library or other program which contains a
notice placed by the copyright holder or other
authorized party saying it may be distributed
under the terms of this Lesser General Public
License (also called "this License"). Each licensee is addressed as "you".
A "library" means a collection of software functions and/or data prepared so as to be conveniently linked with application programs (which
use some of those functions and data) to form
executables.
The "Library", below, refers to any such software library or work which has been distributed
under these terms. A "work based on the
Library" means either the Library or any derivative work under copyright law: that is to say, a
work containing the Library or a portion of it,
either verbatim or with modifications and/or
translated straightforwardly into another language. (Hereinafter, translation is included without limitation in the term "modification".)
"Source code" for a work means the preferred
form of the work for making modifications to it.
For a library, complete source code means all
the source code for all modules it contains, plus
any associated interface definition files, plus
the scripts used to control compilation and
installation of the library.
152
Activities other than copying, distribution and
modification are not covered by this License;
they are outside its scope. The act of running a
program using the Library is not restricted, and
output from such a program is covered only if
its contents constitute a work based on the
Library (independent of the use of the Library in
a tool for writing it). Whether that is true
depends on what the Library does and what the
program that uses the Library does.
1. You may copy and distribute verbatim copies
of the Library's complete source code as you
receive it, in any medium, provided that you
conspicuously and appropriately publish on
each copy an appropriate copyright notice and
disclaimer of warranty; keep intact all the
notices that refer to this License and to the
absence of any warranty; and distribute a copy
of this License along with the Library.
You may charge a fee for the physical act of
transferring a copy, and you may at your option
offer warranty protection in exchange for a fee.
2. You may modify your copy or copies of the
Library or any portion of it, thus forming a work
based on the Library, and copy and distribute
such modifications or work under the terms of
Section 1 above, provided that you also meet all
of these conditions:
a) The modified work must itself be a software
library.
b) You must cause the files modified to carry
prominent notices stating that you changed the
files and the date of any change.
c) You must cause the whole of the work to be
licensed at no charge to all third parties under
the terms of this License.
d) If a facility in the modified Library refers to a
function or a table of data to be supplied by an
application program that uses the facility, other
than as an argument passed when the facility is
invoked, then you must make a good faith
effort to ensure that, in the event an application does not supply such function or table, the
facility still operates, and performs whatever
part of its purpose remains meaningful.
(For example, a function in a library to compute
square roots has a purpose that is entirely welldefined independent of the application. Therefore, Subsection 2d requires that any application-supplied function or table used by this
function must be optional: if the application
does not supply it, the square root function
must still compute square roots.)
These requirements apply to the modified work
as a whole. If identifiable sections of that work
are not derived from the Library, and can be
reasonably considered independent and sepa-
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / appendix.fm / 27.10.08
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Appendix
rate works in themselves, then this License, and
its terms, do not apply to those sections when
you distribute them as separate works. But
when you distribute the same sections as part
of a whole which is a work based on the Library,
the distribution of the whole must be on the
terms of this License, whose permissions for
other licensees extend to the entire whole, and
thus to each and every part regardless of who
wrote it.
Thus, it is not the intent of this section to claim
rights or contest your rights to work written
entirely by you; rather, the intent is to exercise
the right to control the distribution of derivative
or collective works based on the Library.
In addition, mere aggregation of another work
not based on the Library with the Library (or
with a work based on the Library) on a volume
of a storage or distribution medium does not
bring the other work under the scope of this
License.
3. You may opt to apply the terms of the ordinary GNU General Public License instead of this
License to a given copy of the Library. To do
this, you must alter all the notices that refer to
this License, so that they refer to the ordinary
GNU General Public License, version 2, instead
of to this License. (If a newer version than version 2 of the ordinary GNU General Public
License has appeared, then you can specify that
version instead if you wish.) Do not make any
other change in these notices.
Once this change is made in a given copy, it is
irreversible for that copy, so the ordinary GNU
General Public License applies to all subsequent
copies and derivative works made from that
copy.
This option is useful when you wish to copy part
of the code of the Library into a program that is
not a library.
4. You may copy and distribute the Library (or a
portion or derivative of it, under Section 2) in
object code or executable form under the terms
of Sections 1 and 2 above provided that you
accompany it with the complete corresponding
machine-readable source code, which must be
distributed under the terms of Sections 1 and 2
above on a medium customarily used for software interchange.
If distribution of object code is made by offering
access to copy from a designated place, then
offering equivalent access to copy the source
code from the same place satisfies the requirement to distribute the source code, even
though third parties are not compelled to copy
the source along with the object code.
5. A program that contains no derivative of any
portion of the Library, but is designed to work
with the Library by being compiled or linked
with it, is called a "work that uses the Library".
Such a work, in isolation, is not a derivative
work of the Library, and therefore falls outside
the scope of this License.
However, linking a "work that uses the Library"
with the Library creates an executable that is a
derivative of the Library (because it contains
portions of the Library), rather than a "work
that uses the library". The executable is therefore covered by this License.
Section 6 states terms for distribution of such
executables.
When a "work that uses the Library" uses material from a header file that is part of the Library,
the object code for the work may be a derivative
work of the Library even though the source
code is not.
Whether this is true is especially significant if
the work can be linked without the Library, or if
the work is itself a library. The threshold for this
to be true is not precisely defined by law.
If such an object file uses only numerical parameters, data structure layouts and accessors,
and small macros and small inline functions
(ten lines or less in length), then the use of the
object file is unrestricted, regardless of whether
it is legally a derivative work. (Executables containing this object code plus portions of the
Library will still fall under Section 6.)
Otherwise, if the work is a derivative of the
Library, you may distribute the object code for
the work under the terms of Section 6.
Any executables containing that work also fall
under Section 6, whether or not they are linked
directly with the Library itself.
6. As an exception to the Sections above, you
may also combine or link a "work that uses the
Library" with the Library to produce a work containing portions of the Library, and distribute
that work under terms of your choice, provided
that the terms permit modification of the work
for the customer's own use and reverse engineering for debugging such modifications.
You must give prominent notice with each copy
of the work that the Library is used in it and that
the Library and its use are covered by this
License. You must supply a copy of this License.
If the work during execution displays copyright
notices, you must include the copyright notice
for the Library among them, as well as a reference directing the user to the copy of this
License. Also, you must do one of these things:
a) Accompany the work with the complete corresponding machine-readable source code for
153
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / appendix.fm / 27.10.08
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Appendix
the Library including whatever changes were
used in the work (which must be distributed
under Sections 1 and 2 above); and, if the work
is an executable linked with the Library, with
the complete machine-readable "work that uses
the Library", as object code and/or source code,
so that the user can modify the Library and then
relink to produce a modified executable containing the modified Library. (It is understood that
the user who changes the contents of definitions files in the Library will not necessarily be
able to recompile the application to use the
modified definitions.)
b) Use a suitable shared library mechanism for
linking with the Library. A suitable mechanism
is one that (1) uses at run time a copy of the
library already present on the user's computer
system, rather than copying library functions
into the executable, and (2) will operate properly with a modified version of the library, if
the user installs one, as long as the modified
version is interface-compatible with the version
that the work was made with.
c) Accompany the work with a written offer,
valid for at least three years, to give the same
user the materials specified in Subsection 6a,
above, for a charge no more than the cost of
performing this distribution.
d) If distribution of the work is made by offering
access to copy from a designated place, offer
equivalent access to copy the above specified
materials from the same place.
e) Verify that the user has already received a
copy of these materials or that you have already
sent this user a copy.
For an executable, the required form of the
"work that uses the Library" must include any
data and utility programs needed for reproducing the executable from it. However, as a special exception, the materials to be distributed
need not include anything that is normally distributed (in either source or binary form) with
the major components (compiler, kernel, and
so on) of the operating system on which the
executable runs, unless that component itself
accompanies the executable.
It may happen that this requirement contradicts
the license restrictions of other proprietary
libraries that do not normally accompany the
operating system. Such a contradiction means
you cannot use both them and the Library together in an executable that you distribute.
7. You may place library facilities that are a
work based on the Library side-by-side in a single library together with other library facilities
not covered by this License, and distribute such
a combined library, provided that the separate
154
distribution of the work based on the Library
and of the other library facilities is otherwise
permitted, and provided that you do these two
things:
a) Accompany the combined library with a copy
of the same work based on the Library, uncombined with any other library facilities. This must
be distributed under the terms of the Sections
above.
b) Give prominent notice with the combined
library of the fact that part of it is a work based
on the Library, and explaining where to find the
accompanying uncombined form of the same
work.
8. You may not copy, modify, sublicense, link
with, or distribute the Library except as
expressly provided under this License. Any
attempt otherwise to copy, modify, sublicense,
link with, or distribute the Library is void, and
will automatically terminate your rights under
this License. However, parties who have received copies, or rights, from you under this
License will not have their licenses terminated
so long as such parties remain in full compliance.
9. You are not required to accept this License,
since you have not signed it. However, nothing
else grants you permission to modify or distribute the Library or its derivative works. These
actions are prohibited by law if you do not
accept this License. Therefore, by modifying or
distributing the Library (or any work based on
the Library), you indicate your acceptance of
this License to do so, and all its terms and conditions for copying, distributing or modifying
the Library or works based on it.
10. Each time you redistribute the Library (or
any work based on the Library), the recipient
automatically receives a license from the original licensor to copy, distribute, link with or
modify the Library subject to these terms and
conditions. You may not impose any further
restrictions on the recipients' exercise of the
rights granted herein.
You are not responsible for enforcing compliance by third parties with this License.
11. If, as a consequence of a court judgment or
allegation of patent infringement or for any
other reason (not limited to patent issues), conditions are imposed on you (whether by court
order, agreement or otherwise) that contradict
the conditions of this License, they do not
excuse you from the conditions of this License.
If you cannot distribute so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this License and
any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you may not distribute the Library at
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / appendix.fm / 27.10.08
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Appendix
all. For example, if a patent license would not
permit royalty-free redistribution of the Library
by all those who receive copies directly or indirectly through you, then the only way you could
satisfy both it and this License would be to
refrain entirely from distribution of the Library.
If any portion of this section is held invalid or
unenforceable under any particular circumstance, the balance of the section is intended to
apply, and the section as a whole is intended to
apply in other circumstances.
It is not the purpose of this section to induce
you to infringe any patents or other property
right claims or to contest validity of any such
claims; this section has the sole purpose of protecting the integrity of the free software distribution system which is implemented by public
license practices. Many people have made
generous contributions to the wide range of
software distributed through that system in
reliance on consistent application of that system; it is up to the author/donor to decide if he
or she is willing to distribute software through
any other system and a licensee cannot impose
that choice.
This section is intended to make thoroughly
clear what is believed to be a consequence of
the rest of this License.
12. If the distribution and/or use of the Library
is restricted in certain countries either by
patents or by copyrighted interfaces, the original copyright holder who places the Library
under this License may add an explicit geographical distribution limitation excluding those
countries, so that distribution is permitted only
in or among countries not thus excluded. In
such case, this License incorporates the limitation as if written in the body of this License.
13. The Free Software Foundation may publish
revised and/or new versions of the Lesser General Public License from time to time. Such new
versions will be similar in spirit to the present
version, but may differ in detail to address new
problems or concerns.
Each version is given a distinguishing version
number. If the Library specifies a version number of this License which applies to it and "any
later version", you have the option of following
the terms and conditions either of that version
or of any later version published by the Free
Software Foundation. If the Library does not
specify a license version number, you may
choose any version ever published by the Free
Software Foundation.
14. If you wish to incorporate parts of the
Library into other free programs whose distribution conditions are incompatible with these,
write to the author to ask for permission. For
software which is copyrighted by the Free Software Foundation, write to the Free Software
Foundation; we sometimes make exceptions
for this. Our decision will be guided by the two
goals of preserving the free status of all derivatives of our free software and of promoting the
sharing and reuse of software generally.
NO WARRANTY
15. BECAUSE THE LIBRARY IS LICENSED FREE OF
CHARGE, THERE IS NO WARRANTY FOR THE
LIBRARY, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW.
EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING
THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER PARTIES PROVIDE THE LIBRARY "AS IS" WITHOUT
WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED
OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.
THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE LIBRARY IS WITH YOU.
SHOULD THE LIBRARY PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU
ASSUME THE COST OF ALL NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION.
16. IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING WILL
ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER
PARTY WHO MAY MODIFY AND/OR REDISTRIBUTE THE LIBRARY AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE
LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES, INCLUDING ANY
GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THE USE
OR INABILITY TO USE THE LIBRARY (INCLUDING
BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF DATA OR DATA
BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY YOU OR THIRD PARTIES OR A FAILURE
OF THE LIBRARY TO OPERATE WITH ANY OTHER
SOFTWARE), EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER
PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY
OF SUCH DAMAGES.
END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
155
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / appendix.fm / 27.10.08
Appendix
How to Apply These Terms to Your New
Libraries
If you develop a new library, and you want it to
be of the greatest possible use to the public, we
recommend making it free software that everyone can redistribute and change. You can do so
by permitting redistribution under these terms
(or, alternatively, under the terms of the ordinary General Public License).
To apply these terms, attach the following
notices to the library. It is safest to attach them
to the start of each source file to most effectively convey the exclusion of warranty; and
each file should have at least the "copyright"
line and a pointer to where the full notice is
found.
<one line to give the library's name and a brief
idea of what it does.>
Copyright (C) <year> <name of author>
This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under the terms of the
GNU Lesser General Public License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option)
any later version.
This library is distributed in the hope that it will
be useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU Lesser General Public
License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU
Lesser General Public License along with this
library; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA
Also add information on how to contact you by
electronic and paper mail.
You should also get your employer (if you work
as a programmer) or your school, if any, to sign
a "copyright disclaimer" for the library, if necessary. Here is a sample; alter the names:
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Yoyodyne, Inc., hereby disclaims all copyright
interest in the library `Frob' (a library for tweaking knobs) written by James Random Hacker.
<signature of Ty Coon>, 1 April 1990 Ty Coon,
President of Vice
156
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / accessories_SAG.fm / 27.10.08
Accessories
Accessories
Gigaset handsets
Upgrade your Gigaset to a cordless PABX:
Gigaset S67H or S68H handset
HDSP ready
Illuminated graphical colour display (65k colours)
Illuminated keypad
Handsfree talking
Polyphonic ringer tones
Directory for around 250 entries
Picture CLIP
SMS (precondition: CLIP must be enabled)
Headset socket
Bluetooth (Gigaset S68H only)
Room monitor
www.gigaset.com/gigasetS67H
www.gigaset.com/gigasetS68H
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
Gigaset SL37H handset
HDSP ready
Illuminated graphical colour display (65k colours)
Illuminated keypad
Handsfree talking
Polyphonic ringer tones
Directory for around 250 entries
Picture CLIP
SMS (precondition: CLIP must be enabled)
PC interface e.g. for managing directory entries,
ringer tones and screensavers
u Headset socket
u Bluetooth
u Room monitor
u Walky-talky function
www.gigaset.com/gigasetSL37H
Version 4, 16.09.2005
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
157
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / accessories_SAG.fm / 27.10.08
Accessories
Gigaset S45 handset
Illuminated colour display (4096 colours)
Illuminated keypad
Handsfree talking
Polyphonic ringer tones
Directory for around 150 entries
SMS (precondition: CLIP must be enabled)
Headset socket
Room monitor
www.gigaset.com/gigasetS45
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
Gigaset C47H handset
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
Illuminated graphical colour display (65k colours)
Illuminated keypad
Handsfree talking
Polyphonic ringer tones
Directory for around 150 entries
SMS (precondition: CLIP must be enabled)
Headset socket
Room monitor
www.gigaset.com/gigasetC47H
Gigaset repeater
Version 4, 16.09.2005
The Gigaset repeater can be used to increase the reception
range of your Gigaset handset to the base station.
www.gigaset.com/gigasetrepeater
158
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / accessories_SAG.fm / 27.10.08
Accessories
Gigaset HC450 – door intercom for cordless phones
u Use the intercom from your cordless phone –
no need for a fixed home phone
u Intuitive user functions using the display keys
(open door, switch on entry light)
Simple to configure using the handset menu
Forward to outside phone numbers (intercom feature)
Simple to install and register with the Gigaset system
Replaces existing call button – no further cable is needed
Supports the existing doorbell and standard door opener
Configuration options for the second ringer key (separate
intercom call, activating interior lighting, or function such
as first ringer key)
www.gigaset.com/gigasetHC450
u
u
u
u
u
u
Version 4, 16.09.2005
All accessories are available from your mobile phone retailer.
Only use original accessories. This will avoid possible health risks and damage to property, and also ensure that all the relevant regulations are complied with.
159
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / glossary.fm / 27.10.08
Glossary
Glossary
C
Call forwarding
A
ADSL
Asymmetric Digital Subscriber Line
Special form of DSL.
ALG
Application Layer Gateway
NAT control mechanism of a router.
Many routers with integrated NAT use
ALG. ALG lets the data packets in a VoIP
connection pass and adds the public IP
address of the secure private network.
The router's ALG should be deactivated
if the VoIP provider offers a STUN server
or an outbound proxy.
See also: Firewall, NAT, Outbound
proxy, STUN.
Authentication
Restriction of access to a network/service by use of an ID and password to log
in.
Automatic ringback
See Ringback when the number is
busy.
B
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Block dialling
Enter the complete phone number, and
correct it if necessary. Then pick up the
receiver or press the handsfree key to
dial the phone number.
Broadband Internet access
See DSL.
Buddy
Party with whom you exchange brief
messages on the Internet in real time
(chatting).
See also: Instant messaging.
160
CF
Automatic forwarding of a call to a different telephone number. There are
three kinds of call forwarding:
– CFU, Call Forwarding Unconditional
– CFB, Call Forwarding Busy
– CFNR, Call Forwarding No Reply
Call waiting
CW
VoIP provider feature. A beep during a
call indicates that another caller is waiting. You can accept or reject the second
call. You can activate/deactivate the
feature.
Chatting
Form of communication on the Internet. During a chat, brief messages are
exchanged between the communicating parties in real time. Chatting in this
sense is understood to be a written
form of communication.
Client
Application that requests a service
from a server.
Codec
Coder/decoder
Codec is a procedure that digitises and
compresses analogue voice before it is
sent via the Internet and decodes – i.e.
translates into analogue voice – digital
data when voice packets are received.
There are different codecs, with differing degrees of compression, for
instance.
Both parties involved in the telephone
connection (caller/sender and recipient) must use the same codec. This is
negotiated between the sender and the
recipient when establishing a connection.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / glossary.fm / 27.10.08
Glossary
The choice of codec is a compromise
between voice quality, transmission
speed and the necessary bandwidth.
A high level of compression, for example, means that the bandwidth
required for each voice connection is
low. However, it also means that the
time needed to compress/decompress
the data is greater, which increases
execution time for data in the network
and thus impairs voice quality. The time
required increases the delay between
the sender speaking and the recipient
hearing what has been said.
COLP / COLR
Connected Line Identification Presentation/
Restriction
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Service characteristic of a VoIP connection for outgoing calls.
COLP displays the phone number
accepting the call on the calling party's
display unit.
The number of the party accepting the
call is different to the dialled number,
e.g. if the call is forwarded or transferred.
The called party can use COLR (Connected Line Identification Restriction)
to prevent the number from appearing
on the calling party's display.
Consultation call
You are on a call. With a consultation
call, you interrupt the conversation
briefly to establish a connection to
another participant. If you terminate
the connection to this participant
immediately, then this was then this
was a consultation call. If you switch to
and fro between the first and second
participants, it is called Toggling.
D
DHCP
Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol
Internet protocol that handles the automatic assignment of IP addresses to
Network subscribers. The protocol is
made available in the network by a
server. A DHCP server can be a router
for example.
The phone contains a DHCP client. A
router that contains a DHCP server can
assign the IP addresses for the phone
automatically from a defined address
block. The dynamic assignment means
that several Network subscribers can
share one IP address, although they use
it alternately and not simultaneously.
With some routers you can specify that
the IP address for the phone is never
changed.
Displayed name
VoIP provider feature. You can specify
any name that is to be shown to the
other party during a call instead of your
phone number.
DMZ (Demilitarised Zone)
DMZ describes a part of a network that
is outside the firewall.
A DMZ is set up, as it were, between a
network you want to protect (e.g. a
LAN) and a non-secure network (e.g.
the Internet). A DMZ permits unrestricted access from the Internet to only
one or a few network components,
while the other network components
remain secure behind the firewall.
161
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / glossary.fm / 27.10.08
Glossary
DNS
Domain Name System
Hierarchical system that permits the
assignment of IP addresses to Domain
names that are easier to note. This
assignment has to be managed by a
local DNS server in each (W)LAN. The
local DNS server determines the IP
address, if necessary by enquiring
about superordinate DNS servers and
other local DNS servers on the Internet.
You can specify the IP address of the
primary/secondary DNS server.
See also: DynDNS.
Domain name
Name of one (of several) Web server(s)
on the Internet (e.g. Gigaset Home).
The domain name is assigned to the
relevant IP address by DNS.
DSCP
Differentiated Service Code Point
Dynamic DNS
Domain names and IP addresses are
realised via DNS. For Dynamic IP
addresses this service is now
enhanced with "Dynamic DNS"
(DynDNS). This permits the use of a
network component with a dynamic IP
address as a Server on the Internet.
DynDNS ensures that a service can
always be addressed on the Internet
under the same Domain name irrespective of the current IP address.
See Quality of Service (QoS).
DSL
E
Digital Subscriber Line
Explicit Call Transfer
Data transfer technology that allows
Internet access with, for e.g. 1.5 Mbps
over a conventional telephone line.
Preconditions: DSL modem and the
appropriate service offered by the
Internet provider.
DSLAM
Digital Subscriber Line Access Multiplexer
The DSLAM is a switch cabinet in an
exchange at which all subscriber connectors converge.
DTMF
Dual Tone Multi-Frequency
Another description for dual tone
multi-frequency dialling.
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Dynamic IP address
A dynamic IP address is assigned to a
network component automatically via
DHCP. The dynamic IP address for a
network component can change every
time it registers or at certain time intervals.
See also: Static IP address
DynDNS
162
ECT
Participant A calls participant B. He
puts the connection on hold and calls
participant C. Rather than connect everyone in a three-party conference, A
now transfers participant B to C and
hangs up.
EEPROM
Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only
Memory
Memory building block in your phone
with fixed data (e.g. default and customised settings) and data saved automatically (e.g. entries to the list of callers).
Ethernet network
Wired LAN.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / glossary.fm / 27.10.08
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Glossary
F
G
Firewall
You can use a firewall to protect your
network against unauthorised external
access. This involves combining various
measures and technologies (hard and/
or software) to control the flow of data
between a private network you wish to
protect and an unprotected network
(e.g. the Internet).
See also: NAT.
Firmware
Device software in which basic information is saved for the functioning of a
device. A new version of the firmware
can be loaded into the device's memory
(firmware update) to correct errors or
update the device software.
Flat rate
Billing system for an Internet connection. The Internet provider charges a
set monthly fee. There are no additional charges for the duration of the
connection or number of connections.
Fragmentation
Data packets that are too big are split
into smaller packets (fragments) before
they are transferred. They are put
together again when they reach the
recipient (defragmented).
Full duplex
Data transmission mode in which data
can be sent and received at the same
time.
G.711 a law, G.711 µ law
Standard for a Codec.
G.711 delivers a very good voice quality that corresponds to that in the ISDN
fixed line. As there is little compression,
the necessary bandwidth is around 64
kbit/s per voice connection, but the
delay caused by coding/decoding is
only 0.125 ms.
"a law" describes the European standard and "µ law" describes the North
American/Japanese equivalent.
G.722
Standard for a Codec.
G.722 is a broadband language codec
with a bandwidth of 50 Hz to 7 kHz, a
net transfer rate of 64 kbit/s per language connection and integrated
speech pause recognition and comfort
noise generation (silence suppression).
G.722 delivers very good voice quality.
A higher sampling rate provides clearer
and better voice quality than other
codecs and enables a speech tone in
High Definition Sound Performance
(HDSP).
G.726
Standard for a Codec.
G.726 delivers a good voice quality. It is
inferior to the quality with codec G.711
but better than with G.729.
G.729A/B
Standard for a Codec.
The voice quality is rather lower with
G.729A/B. As a result of the high level
of compression, the necessary bandwidth is only around 8 kbit/s per voice
connection, but the delay is around
15 ms.
163
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / glossary.fm / 27.10.08
Glossary
Gateway
Connects two different Networks,
e.g. a router as an Internet gateway.
For phone calls from VoIP to the telephone network, a gateway has to be
connected to the IP network and the
telephone network (gateway/VoIP provider). It forwards calls from VoIP to the
telephone network as required.
Gateway provider
See SIP provider.
Global IP address
See IP address.
GSM
Global System for Mobile Communication
Originally, European standard for
mobile networks. GSM can now be
described as a worldwide standard. In
the USA and Japan national standards
are now more frequently supported
than in the past.
H
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Headset
Combination of microphone and headphone. A headset makes handsfree
talking more convenient. There are
headsets available that are connected
to the handset by a cable.
HTTP proxy
Server via which the Network subscribers can process their Internet traffic.
Hub
Uses one Infrastructure network to
connect several Network subscribers.
All data sent to the hub by one network
subscriber is forwarded to all network
subscribers.
See also: Gateway, Router.
164
I
IEEE
Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers
International body that defines standards in electronics and electrotechnology, concerned in particular with the
standardisation of LAN technology,
transmission protocols, data transfer
rate and wiring.
Infrastructure network
Network with central structure: all Network subscribers communicate via a
central Router.
Instant messaging
Service that uses a client program to
allow chatting in real time, i.e. to send
brief messages to other subscribers on
the Internet.
Internet
Global WAN. A series of protocols have
been defined for exchanging data,
known by the name TCP/IP.
All Network subscribers are identifiable via their IP address. DNS assigns a
Domain name to the IP address.
Important services on the Internet
include the World Wide Web (WWW), email, file transfer and discussion
forums.
Internet Service Provider
Enables access to the Internet for a fee.
IP (Internet Protocol)
TCP/IP protocol on the Internet. IP is
responsible for addressing subscribers
in a Network using IP addresses and
routes data from the sender to the
recipient. IP determines the paths
(routing) along which the data packets
travel.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / glossary.fm / 27.10.08
Glossary
IP address
A unique address for a network component within a network based on the
TCP/IP protocols (e.g. LAN, Internet).
On the Internet, domain names are
usually assigned instead of IP
addresses. DNS assigns the corresponding IP address to the domain
name.
The IP address has four parts (decimal
numbers between 0 and 255) separated by full stops (e.g. 230.94.233.2).
The IP address is made up of the network number and the number of the
Network subscribers (e.g. phone).
Depending on the Subnet mask, the
front one, two or three parts make up
the network number and the rest of the
IP address addresses the network component. The network number of all the
components in any one network must
be identical.
IP addresses can be assigned automatically with DHCP (dynamic IP addresses)
or manually (static IP addresses).
See also: DHCP.
IP pool range
Range of IP addresses that the DHCP
server can use to assign dynamic IP
addresses.
Local SIP Port
See SIP port/Local SIP port.
M
MAC address
Media Access Control Address
Hardware address by means of which
each network device (e.g. network
card, switch, phone) can be uniquely
identified worldwide. It consists of 6
parts (hexadecimal numbers) separated by a "-" (e.g. 00-90-65-44-00-3A).
The MAC address is assigned by the
manufacturer and cannot be changed.
Mbps
Million bits per second
Unit of the transmission speed in a network.
MRU
Maximum Receive Unit
Defines the maximum user data volume within a data packet.
MTU
Maximum Transmission Unit
Defines the maximum length of a data
packet that can be carried over the network at a time.
Music on hold
Music on hold
Music that is played while you are on a
Consultation call or Toggling. The
waiting participant hears music while
on hold.
L
LAN
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Local Area Network
Network with a restricted physical
range. A LAN can be wireless (WLAN)
and/or wired.
Local IP address
The local or private IP address is the
address for a network component in
the local network (LAN). The network
operator can assign any address he or
she wants. Devices that act as a link
from a local network to the Internet
(gateway or router) have a public and a
private IP address.
See also IP address.
N
NAT
Network Address Translation
Method for converting (private) IP
addresss to one or more (public) IP
addresses. NAT enables the IP
addresses of Network subscriberss
(e.g. VoIP telephones) in a LAN to be
concealed behind a shared IP address
for the Router on the Internet.
VoIP telephones behind a NAT router
cannot be reached by VoIP servers (on
account of the private IP address). In
order to "get around" NAT, it is possible
165
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / glossary.fm / 27.10.08
Glossary
to use (alternatively) ALG in the router,
STUN in the VoIP telephone, or for the
VoIP provider to use an Outbound
proxy.
If an outbound proxy is made available
you must allow for this in the VoIP settings for your phone.
Network
Group of devices. Devices can be connected in either wired or wireless
mode.
Networks can also differ in range and
structure:
– Range: local networks (LAN) or
wide-area networks (WAN)
– Structure: Infrastructure network
or ad-hoc network
Network subscribers
Devices and computers that are connected to each other in a network, e.g.
servers, PCs and phones.
O
Outbound proxy
Alternative NAT control mechanism to
STUN and ALG.
Outbound proxies are implemented by
the VoIP provider in firewall/NAT environments as an alternative to SIP proxy
server. They control data traffic
through the firewall.
Outbound proxy and STUN servers
should not be used simultaneously.
See also: STUNand NAT.
Version 4, 16.09.2005
P
Paging (handset search)
A base station function to locate registered handsets. The base station establishes a connection to every registered
handset. The handsets start to ring.
Paging is activated by briefly pressing
the button on the base station and is
deactivated by briefly pressing the
same button again.
166
PIN
Personal Identification Number
Protects against unauthorised use.
When the PIN is activated a number
combination has to be entered in order
to access a protected area.
You can protect your base station configuration data with a system PIN (4digit number combination).
Port
Data is exchanged between two applications in a Network via a port.
Port forwarding
The Internet gateway (e.g. your router)
forwards data packets from the Internet that are directed to a certain Port to
the port concerned. This allows servers
in the LAN to offer services on the
Internet without you needing a public
IP address.
Port number
Indicates a specific application of Network subscribers. Depending on the
setting in the LAN, the port number is
permanently assigned or else it is
newly assigned with each access.
The combination of IP address/Port
number uniquely identifies the recipient or sender of a data packet within a
network.
Pre-dialling
See Block dialling.
Private IP address
See Public IP address.
Protocol
Describes the agreements for communicating within a Network. It contains
rules for opening, administering and
closing a connection, about data formats, time frames and possible error
handling.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / glossary.fm / 27.10.08
Glossary
Proxy/Proxy server
Computer program that controls the
exchange of data between Client and
Server in computer networks. If the
phone sends a query to the VoIP server,
the proxy acts as a server towards the
phone and as a client towards the
server. A proxy is addressed via IP
address/Domain names and Port.
Public IP address
The public IP address is the address for
a network component on the Internet.
It is assigned by the Internet Service
Provider. Devices that act as a link from
a local network to the Internet (gateway, router) have a public and a local IP
address.
See also: IP address, NAT
Q
Quality of Service (QoS)
Describes the Quality of Service in communication networks. Differentiations
are made between various Quality of
Service classes.
QoS influences the flow of data packets
on the Internet, e.g. by prioritising data
packets, reserving bandwidth and data
packet optimisation.
In VoIP networks, QoS influences the
voice quality. If the whole infrastructure (router, network server etc.) has
QoS, the voice quality is better, i.e.
fewer delays, less echoing, less crackling.
R
RAM
Random Access Memory
Memory in which you have reading and
storage rights. Items such as melodies
and screen pictures are saved in the
RAM after you have loaded them onto
the phone via the Web configurator.
Registrar
The registrar manages the Network
subscribers' current IP addresses.
When you register with your VoIP provider, your current IP address is saved
on the registrar. This means you can
also be reached when on the move.
Ringback when the call is not answered
= CCNR (Completion of Calls on No
Reply). If a called party does not
respond when called, a caller can
arrange an automatic ringback. As
soon as the destination phone has
completed a call and is free again the
caller is rung back. This feature must be
supported by the exchange. The ringback request is automatically cancelled
after about 2 hours (depending on the
VoIP provider).
Ringback when the number is busy
= CCBS (Completion of Calls to Busy
Subscriber). If a caller hears the busy
tone, he or she can activate the ringback function. As soon as the connection is free the caller is rung back. As
soon as the caller lifts his receiver the
connection is made automatically.
ROM
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Read Only Memory
A type of memory that can only be
read, as opposed to RAM which can be
both read and written.
Router
Routes data packets within a network
and between different networks via the
quickest route. Can connect Ethernet
networks and WLAN. Can be a Gateway to the Internet.
167
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / glossary.fm / 27.10.08
Glossary
Routing
Routing is the transfer of data packets
to another subscriber in your network.
On their way to the recipient, the data
packets are sent from one router to the
next until they reach their destination.
If data packets were not forwarded in
this way, a network like the Internet
would not be possible. Routing connects the individual networks to this
global system.
A router is a part of this system; it transfers data packets both within a local
network and from one network to the
next. Transfer of data from one network to another is performed on the
basis of a common protocol.
RTP
Realtime Transport Protocol
Global standard for transferring audio
and video data. Often used in conjunction with UDP. In this case, RTP packets
are embedded in UDP packets.
RTP port
(Local) Port that is used to send and
receive voice data packets for VoIP.
Version 4, 16.09.2005
S
Server
Provides a service to other Network
subscribers (Clients). The term can
indicate a computer/PC or an application. A server is addressed via IP
address/Domain namen and Port.
SIP (Session Initiation Protocol)
Signalling protocol independent of
voice communication. Used for establishing and ending a call. It is also possible to define parameters for voice
transmission.
SIP address
See URI.
SIP port/Local SIP port
(Local) Port which is used to send and
receive SIP signalling data for VoIP.
SIP provider
See VoIP provider.
168
SIP proxy server
IP address of your VoIP provider's gateway server.
Static IP address
A static IP address is assigned to a network component manually during network configuration. Unlike the
Dynamic IP address a static (fixed) IP
address never changes.
STUN
Simple Transversal of UDP over NAT
NAT control mechanism.
STUN is a data protocol for VoIP telephones. STUN replaces the private IP
address in the data packets of the VoIP
telephone with the public address of
the secure private network. To control
data transfer, a STUN server is also
required on the Internet. STUN cannot
be implemented with symmetric NATs.
See also: ALG, Firewall, NAT,
Outbound proxy.
Subnet
Segment of a Network.
Subnet mask
IP addresses consist of a fixed line
number and a variable subscriber
number. The network number is identical for all Network subscribers. The
proportion of the IP address made up of
the network number is determined in
the subnet mask. In the subnet mask
255.255.255.0, for e.g., the first three
parts of the IP address are the network
number and the last part the subscriber
number.
Symmetric NAT
A symmetric NAT assigns different
external IP addresses and port numbers
to the same internal IP addresses and
port numbers – depending on the
external target address.
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / glossary.fm / 27.10.08
Glossary
T
TCP
Transmission Control Protocol
Transport protocol. Session-based
transmission protocol: it sets up, monitors and terminates a connection
between sender and recipient for transporting data.
TLS
Transport Layer Security
Protocol for encrypting data transmissions on the Internet. TLS is a superordinated Transport protocol.
Toggling
Toggling allows you to switch between
two callers or between a conference
call and an individual caller without
allowing the waiting caller to screen
the call.
Transmission rate
Speed at which data is transmitted in
the WAN or LAN. The transfer rate is
measured in data units per unit of time
(Mbit/s).
Transport protocol
Controls data transport between communication partners (applications).
See also: UDP, TCP, TLS.
U
UDP
User Datagram Protocol
Transport protocol. Unlike TCP, UDP is
a non session-based protocol. It does
not establish a fixed connection. The
data packets (datagrams) are sent as
broadcast. The recipient is solely
responsible for making sure the data is
received. The sender is not notified
about whether it is received.
URI
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Uniform Resource Identifier
Character sequence for identifying
resources (e.g. e-mail recipient,
http://gigaset.com, files).
On the Internet URIs are used as a uniform identification for resources. URIs
are also described as SIP addresses.
URIs can be entered in the phone as a
number. By dialling a URI you can call
an Internet subscriber with VoIP equipment.
URL
Universal Resource Locator
Globally unique address of a domain on
the Internet.
A URL is a subtype of URI. URLs identify
a resource by its location on the Internet. For historical reasons the term is
often used as a synonym for URI.
User identification
User ID
Name/number combination for access,
e.g. to your VoIP account.
V
Voice codec
See Codec.
VoIP
Voice over Internet Protocol
Telephone calls are no longer placed
and transmitted over the telephone
network but over the Internet (or other
IP networks).
VoIP provider
A VoIP, SIP or Gateway provider is an
Internet service provider that provides
a Gateway for Internet telephony. As
the phone works with the SIP standard,
your provider must support the SIP
standard.
The provider routes calls from VoIP to
the telephone network (analogue,
ISDN and mobile radio) and vice versa.
W
WAN
Wide Area Network
Wide-area network that is unrestricted
in terms of area (e.g. Internet).
169
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / S675-S685-IP_Lang_BASIX.fm / 27.10.08
Index
Index
Version 4, 16.09.2005
A
Access protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
Access to Web configurator
from other networks . . . . . . . . . 110
Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157
Account name (e-mail) . . . . . . . . . . . 128
Activate annex B for G.729 . . . . . . . . 119
Activating
advisory tones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
answer machine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
answer machine from
external location . . . . . . . . . . . 67
appointment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
auto answer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
handset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1, 31
handsfree talking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
keypad lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
network mailbox . . . . . . . . . . . 78, 126
repeater mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
room monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
two-way recording . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
withholding phone numbers . . . . . . 37
Address assignment (IP address) . . . . 109
ADSL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
Advisory tones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
Alarm clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
Alert tone
activating/deactivating . . . . . . . . . . 90
ALG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
Alternative DNS server
(Web configurator) . . . . . . . . . . 109
Anniversary
deactivating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
displaying missed ones . . . . . . . . . . 93
missed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45, 93
storing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
Announce only mode (ans. mach.) . . . 61
Announcement (answer machine) . . . 63
Anonymous calling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Answer and record mode
(ans. mach.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
Answer machine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
activating/deactivating . . . . . . . . . . 61
assigning receive numbers . . . . . . 121
define for fast access . . . . . . . . . . . 79
deleting messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
170
list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
playing back messages . . . . . . . . . . 63
record announcement/notification . 62
remote operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
scrolling back. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
scrolling forward . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
Application Layer Gateway (ALG) . . . 160
Application signal (recall key) . . . . . 122
Application type (recall key). . . . . . . 122
Appointments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92, 93
activating/deactivating . . . . . . . . . . 92
deleting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
displaying missed ones. . . . . . . . . . 93
managing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
Area code
dialling automatically . . . . . . . . . . 123
entering own area code . . . . . . . . 123
setting own area code . . . . . . 95, 123
Area code predialling
activating/deactivating . . . . . . . . . 123
Assigning a key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
Asymmetric Digital Subscriber Line . 160
Attaching the belt clip . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
Audio (DTMF signalling) . . . . . . . . . 122
Authentication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
Authorisation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
Auto answer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
activating/deactivating . . . . . . . . . . 88
Auto configuration code . . . . . . 15, 112
Automatic configuration
e. VoIP connection . . . . . . . . . 15, 112
Automatic redial . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
Automatic version check . . . . . . . . . 133
Available codecs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
Away from computer (messenger) . . . 73
B
Base selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Base station
activating/deactivating eco mode . . 20
changing system PIN . . . . . . . . . . . 96
checking service information . . . . 142
connecting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
connecting with fixed line network . 14
connecting with mains power
supply. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
connecting with router. . . . . . . . . . 15
operating on PABX . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
power consumption . . . . . . . . . . . 145
reducing power consumption . . . . . 20
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / S675-S685-IP_Lang_BASIX.fm / 27.10.08
Index
reducing transmission power . . . . . 20
restoring to factory settings. . . . . . . 96
selecting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
setting default connection . . . 98, 119
setting up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
updating firmware . . . . . . . . . 98, 132
wall mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
Battery
charging. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1, 11
display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1, 11
icon . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1, 11
inserting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
recommended batteries . . . . . . . . 145
tone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
Best base station . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Birthday, see Anniversary
Block dialling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
Bluetooth
accepting a call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
activating/deactivating . . . . . . . . . . 94
changing device name . . . . . . . . . . 95
de-registering device . . . . . . . . . . . 94
list of known devices. . . . . . . . . . . . 94
registering device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
transferring directory (vCard) . . . . . 44
Broadband connections . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
Broadband Internet access . . . . . . . . 160
Broadband speech codec . . . . . 117, 163
Buddy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71, 160
buddy messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
calling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
checking information . . . . . . . . . . . 74
list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
opening list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
status changes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Busy (messenger) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
Buttons (Web configurator) . . . . . . . 107
Version 4, 16.09.2005
C
Calendar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
Call
accepting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
accepting (Bluetooth) . . . . . . . . . . . 29
disconnecting (toggling) . . . . . . 38, 40
ending . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
external . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
forwarding (VoIP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
internal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
number/name display . . . . . . . . . . . 29
picking up from answer machine . . 64
rejecting external . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
transferring (connecting) . . . . . . . . 83
two-way recording . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Call acceptance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Call display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
fixed line network . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
name from online directory . . 30, 129
VoIP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Call duration display . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
Call forwarding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
configuring (VoIP) . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
fixed line network . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Gigaset.net . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39, 121
VoIP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
VoIP (handset) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
VoIP (Web configurator) . . . . . . . . 121
Call placing, see Call forwarding
Call screening during recording . . . . . 65
Call waiting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
accepting/rejecting (fixed line
network) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
accepting/rejecting (VoIP) . . . . . . . . 40
activating/deactivating . . . . . . . . . . 38
activating/deactivating (fixed line
network) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
activating/deactivating (VoIP) . . . . . 39
internal call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
Call-by-call list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Call-by-call numbers . . . . . . . . . . 41, 51
Calling
anonymously . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
entering IP address . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
external . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
from classified directory . . . . . . . . . 47
from online directory . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Gigaset.net . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35, 36
internal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
via VoIP/fixed line network . . . . . . . 26
Calling Line Identification . . . . . . . . . 29
Calling Line Identification
Presentation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Calls list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
Cancelling
dialling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
operation . . . . . . . . . . . . 32, 33, 107
ring back (fixed line network) . . . . . 39
171
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / S675-S685-IP_Lang_BASIX.fm / 27.10.08
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Index
Care of the telephone . . . . . . . . . . . 136
CF, see Call forwarding
Changing
dialling mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
earpiece volume . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
handsfree volume . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
internal number . . . . . . . . . . . 82, 130
system PIN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
to summertime. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134
Character set table,
see Special characters
Charge saving function
(remote operation) . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Charge status display (battery) . . . . 1, 11
Charging cradle
connecting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
wall mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
Chatting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71, 160
with buddies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
Checking EEPROM version . . . . . . . . 135
Classified directory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
CLI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Client . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
CLIP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
CLIP picture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29, 42, 90
Codecs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
available codecs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
Colour scheme (display) . . . . . . . . . . . 86
COLP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30, 161
COLR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30, 161
Conference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
Conference call
VoIP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
Configuration
of phone via PC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
VoIP connection (automatic) . . . . . 112
Configuring
network mailbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
VoIP connection (handset) . . . . . . 100
VoIP connection (Web config.). . . . 110
Confirmation tone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
Connected Line Identification
Presentation/Restriction . . . . 30, 161
Connecting
charging cradle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
PC with Web configurator . . . . . . . 104
to the Web configurator . . . . . . . . 104
172
Connection
activating (VoIP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
Internet (troubleshooting) . . . . . . . 18
name/provider (Web config.) . . . . 111
to Gigaset.net . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
to messenger server . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Connection assistant
starting (getting started) . . . . . . . . 16
Connection name
fixed line network . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
VoIP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
Connection socket for headset . . . . 1, 19
Connection type
selecting (display key) . . . . . . . . . . 26
selecting (talk key) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
Consultation call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
ending . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
external (fixed line network) . . . . . 38
external (VoIP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
internal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32, 84
Contrast (display) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Control key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Correcting incorrect entries . . . . . . . . 33
Cost control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8, 51
defining dialling plans . . . . . . . . . 124
Customer Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
D
Data packets, fragmentation . . . . . . 163
Data server for firmware update . . . 132
Date
set manually . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
transferring from time server . . . . 134
Deactivating
advisory tones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
answer machine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
appointment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
appointment reminder . . . . . . . . . . 93
auto answer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
handset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1, 31
handsfree talking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
keypad lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
network mailbox . . . . . . . . . . 78, 126
repeater mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
room monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
two-way recording . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
withholding phone numbers . . . . . 37
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / S675-S685-IP_Lang_BASIX.fm / 27.10.08
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Index
Default settings
handset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
Delete key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Deleting
announcement for answer
machine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
characters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
e-mail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
message (answer machine) . . . . . . . 64
Demilitarised Zone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
De-registering
from Web configurator . . . . . . . . . 105
handset from base station . . . . . . . . 82
Destination number
room monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
Device (Bluetooth)
changing name . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
de-registering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
registering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
DHCP. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161, 162
Dialling
cancelling. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
IP address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
with directory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42
with quick dial . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43, 87
Dialling plans . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8, 51, 124
activating/deactivating . . . . . . . . . 125
defining . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
deleting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
for emergency numbers . . . . . . . . 125
Differentiated Service Code Point . . . 162
Digit key
assigning a number/function . . . . . . 87
Digital Subscriber Line . . . . . . . . . . . 162
Digital Subscriber Line
Access Multiplexer . . . . . . . . . . . 162
Directory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
copying number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
deleting (Web configurator) . . . . . 131
editing via PC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
Gigaset.net . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
in a file on the PC (vCard format) . . 132
loading from PC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32, 45
order of entries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
saving anniversary . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
saving entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
saving numbers from SMS text . . . . 56
searching for an entry . . . . . . . . . . 46
selecting entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42
sending entry/list to handset . . . . . 43
storing SMS sender's number . . . . . 56
transferring a vCard (Bluetooth) . . . 44
transferring to/from PC . . . . . . . . . 130
using to enter numbers . . . . . . . . . 44
Display
backlight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
call duration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
caller's number (CLI/CLIP) . . . . . . . . 29
changing display language . . . . . . . 86
colour scheme/contrast . . . . . . . . . 86
in idle status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
memory (directory) . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
memory (My stuff) . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
missed appointment/anniversary . . 93
name from online directory . . 30, 129
screensaver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
wrong language . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Display keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1, 32
assigning a number/function . . . . . 87
change configuration . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Displayed name (VoIP) . . . . . . . 113, 161
Disposal
electrical and electronic devices . . . . 7
DMZ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
DNS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
DNS server
alternative (Web configurator) . . . 109
preferred (handset) . . . . . . . . . . . 101
preferred (Web configurator) . . . . 109
Do not disturb (messenger) . . . . . . . . 73
Domain . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
Domain name . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
Domain Name System . . . . . . . . . . . 162
Draft message list (SMS) . . . . . . . . . . 54
DSCP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
DSL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
DSLAM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
DTMF (tone dialling) . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
DTMF-reminder for VoIP . . . . . . . . . 122
Dynamic DNS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
Dynamic Host Configuration
Protocol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
Dynamic IP address . . . . . . . . . 109, 162
DynDNS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
173
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / S675-S685-IP_Lang_BASIX.fm / 27.10.08
Index
E
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Earpiece mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
Earpiece volume . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
EATONI (predictive text) . . . . . . . . . . 148
Echo service
Gigaset.net . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
ECO DECT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
Eco mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
E-mail
account name . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
entering access data . . . . . . . . . . . 128
incoming e-mail server . . . . . . . . . 128
list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
messages whilst making a
connection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
notification. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
registration name/password . . . . . 128
settings (Web config.) . . . . . . . . . . 128
viewing the message header . . . . . . 69
viewing the sender's address . . . . . . 70
Emergency numbers
dialling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
dialling plans for . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
when keypad lock is active . . . . . . . . 7
End call key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1, 27, 28
Ending, call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Entering
access data (e-mail) . . . . . . . . . . . 128
flash . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
pause . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Entering user data (VoIP)
with handset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
with Web configurator . . . . . . . . . 113
Error handling
messenger . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
Error tone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
Ethernet network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
Example
menu input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
multiple line input . . . . . . . . . . . . 147
Explicit Call Transfer . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
External call
forwarding to ans. mach. . . . . . . . . 65
External consultation call
fixed line network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
VoIP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
174
F
Factory settings
base station . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
Fast access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79
answer machine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
directory entries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
Firewall . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
Firmware . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
automatic update . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
checking version . . . . . . . . . 135, 142
starting update (handset) . . . . . . . . 98
starting update (Web config.) . . . . 132
update from local PC . . . . . . . . . . 133
update, automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
version on delivery . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
Firmware update . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
Fixed line network
accepting/rejecting call waiting . . . 38
activating/deactivating call waiting . 38
anonymous calling . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
call forwarding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
cancelling ring back . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
connection name . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
enter network mailbox . . . . . . . . . . 78
external consultation call . . . . . . . . 38
settings for calls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
toggling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
withholding phone numbers . . . . . 37
Fixed line network connection
creating settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
line suffix . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
Flat rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
Fragmentation of data packets. . . . . 163
Free software, licences . . . . . . . . . . 150
Full duplex . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
G
G.711 µ law . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
G.711 a law . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
G.722 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9, 117
G.722 Broadband language codec . . 117
G.726 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
G.729 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Gateway . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164
Gateway provider . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164
Gigaset config. . . . . . . . . . . . . 104, 105
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / S675-S685-IP_Lang_BASIX.fm / 27.10.08
Index
Gigaset HDSP, see HDSP
Gigaset.net . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
(de)activating the connection . . . . 116
call forwarding . . . . . . . . . . . . 39, 121
calling subscriber . . . . . . . . . . . 35, 36
changing/deleting own name . . . . . 36
directory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
Echo service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
entering name . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17, 36
Jabber server . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
messaging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
searching for subscriber . . . . . . . . . 34
Global IP address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164
Global System for
Mobile Communication . . . . . . . 164
GNU Lesser General Public License . . 150
Going online (messenger) . . . . . . . . . 72
Group call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
GSM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164
Guarantee Certificate . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
Version 4, 16.09.2005
H
Handset
activating/deactivating . . . . . . . . 1, 31
activating/deactivating advisory
tones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
assigning a receive number . . . . . . 120
assigning a send number . . . . . . . 120
base station selection . . . . . . . . . . . 82
changing internal names . . . . . 83, 130
changing internal number . . . . 82, 130
changing name . . . . . . . . . . . 83, 130
changing to a different base
station . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
changing to best reception . . . . . . . 82
checking service information. . . . . 142
contact with liquid . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
de-registering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
display backlight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
display language . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
earpiece volume . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
handsfree volume . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
idle status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32, 130
locating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
loudspeaker volume . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
muting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
operating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
reducing transmission power . . . . . 20
registering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12, 81
resetting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
restoring to factory settings . . . . . . 96
screensaver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
setting (individual) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
setting up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
transferring a call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
using room monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
using several . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
Handset directory, see Directory
Handset operating time
in room monitor mode . . . . . . . . . . 85
Handsfree
activating/deactivating . . . . . . . . . . 31
key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
talking. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
Hash key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1, 31
HDSP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8, 9, 117
Headset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1, 19, 164
Hearing aids . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
High Definition Sound Performance,
see HDSP
HTTP proxy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164
Hub . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164
I
Icon
alarm clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
answer machine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
new message . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
new messenger message . . . . . . . . 75
new SMS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
ringer tone deactivated . . . . . . . . . 89
Idle status
back to . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
IEEE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164
Incoming e-mail server (e-mail) . . . . 128
Incoming message list
opening (SMS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
Incoming message list (e-mail)
opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Incorrect input (correction) . . . . . . . . 33
Info messages (messenger) . . . . . . . . 75
Info services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
configuring (Internet) . . . . . . . . . 129
Infrastructure network . . . . . . . . . . 164
175
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / S675-S685-IP_Lang_BASIX.fm / 27.10.08
Index
Input language (message) . . . . . . . . 149
Installing, base station . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
Instant messaging . . . . . . . 71, 126, 164
preconditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Institute of Electrical and
Electronics Engineers . . . . . . . . . 164
Interface language
handset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Web configurator . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Internal call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
call waiting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
Internal consultation call . . . . . . . 32, 84
Internet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164
access (broadband) . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
no connection to . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
protocol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164
service provider . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164
IP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164
IP address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
assigning (handset) . . . . . . . . . . . 101
assigning (Web configurator) . . . . 109
automatically obtaining one . 101, 109
checking (handset) . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
checking (Web configurator) . . . . . 135
dialling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
displaying on handset . . . . . . . . . . . . 2
dynamic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
global . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164
local . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
private . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
public. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
static . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
IP address type . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101, 109
IP configuration
handset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
Web configurator . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
IP pool range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
J
Jabber ID (messenger) . . . . . . . . . . . 127
Jabber server (messenger) . . . . . . . . 127
Jabber server port (messenger) . . . . 127
Version 4, 16.09.2005
K
Key 1 (fast access) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1, 66
assigning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79
Key click . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
Keypad
change configuration . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Keypad lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7, 31
176
Keys
assigning directory entry . . . . . . . . 43
call-by-call list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
cancel key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
control key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1, 32
delete key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
display keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1, 32
end call key . . . . . . . . . . 1, 27, 28, 33
fast access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1, 66
handsfree key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
hash key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1, 31
keypad lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
message key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1, 48
on/off key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
paging key (base station) . . . . . . . . . 2
quick dial . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
recall key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
star key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1, 89
talk key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
L
LAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
Language
handset/display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Web configurator . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Last number redial . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
LGPL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
Licences, free software . . . . . . . . . . 150
Line suffix
dialling with . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
display (Web configurator) . . . . . . 111
Line type for outgoing calls,
see Standard connection
Linking, see SMS
Liquid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
List
answer machine list . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
calls list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
e-mail notifications . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
handsets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32, 130
known devices (Bluetooth) . . . . . . . 94
last number redial list. . . . . . . . . . . 48
missed calls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
network mailbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
Local Area Network . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
Local communication ports . . . . . . . 122
Local IP address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
Local network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
Local SIP port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / S675-S685-IP_Lang_BASIX.fm / 27.10.08
Index
Lock (keypad lock) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
Login password
messenger . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
Lost connection
messenger . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72, 77
Loudspeaker volume . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Version 4, 16.09.2005
M
MAC address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
checking (handset) . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
checking (Web configurator) . . . . . 135
Mailbox ID, see SMS
Mailboxes, see SMS
Main menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21, 33
Mains adapter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
Making calls
accepting a call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
cost-effective calls . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
external (VoIP, fixed line network) . . 26
internal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
Maximum Receive Unit. . . . . . . . . . . 165
Maximum Transmission Unit. . . . . . . 165
Mbps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
Media Access Control . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
Medical appliances . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
Memory
directory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
My stuff . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
Menu
end tone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
going back one menu level . . . . 32, 33
menu guidance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
menu input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
phone overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Web configurator overview . . . . . . . 25
Menu bar (Web configurator) . . . . . . 106
Message
answer machine list . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
deleting (answer machine) . . . . . . . 64
deleting (e-mail) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
deleting (messenger) . . . . . . . . . . . 76
marking as "new" (ans. mach.) . . . . 64
new message icon . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
playback via remote operation
(ans. mach.). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
playing (network mailbox) . . . . . . . 80
playing back . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
playing back (answer machine) . . . 50
reading the subject (e-mail) . . . . . . 69
receiving (messenger) . . . . . . . . . . 75
receiving (SMS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
writing/sending (messenger) . . . . . 76
writing/sending (SMS) . . . . . . . . . . 54
Message key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
opening lists . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
Message list
answer machine . . . . . . . . . . . 50, 63
e-mail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
messenger. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
network mailbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
SMS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
Messaging via Gigaset.net . . . . . . . . 127
Messenger . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
account . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
calling buddy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
change own status. . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
entering access data . . . . . . . . . . 126
error handling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
errors when sending . . . . . . . . . . . 77
lost connection . . . . . . . . . . . . 72, 77
message list. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
priority . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
resource name . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
Messenger message
deleting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
reading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
receiving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
writing/sending . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
Messenger server . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
establishing a connection . . . . . . . . 72
Microphone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
muting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
Million bits per second . . . . . . . . . . 165
Missed
anniversary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
appointment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
calls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
MRU . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
MTU . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
Multiple line input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147
Music . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
Music on hold . . . . . . . . . . . 31, 97, 165
Muting
handset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
My stuff . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
177
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / S675-S685-IP_Lang_BASIX.fm / 27.10.08
Index
N
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Name
changing name of the
handset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83, 130
displaying (VoIP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
fixed line network
connection. . . . . . . . . . . 112, 116
of caller from online directory . 30, 129
NAT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
symmetric . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
updating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
Navigation area (Web config.) . . . . . 107
Network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
Ethernet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
Network Address Translation . . . . . . 165
Network area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
Network mailbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
activating/deactivating . . . . . . 78, 126
calling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79, 80
define for fast access . . . . . . . . . . . 79
entering number . . . . . . . . . . 78, 126
list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
Network MB, see Network mailbox
Network provider (numbers list) . . . . . 41
Network services
fixed line network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
fixed line network and VoIP . . . . . . . 37
settings for fixed line network
calls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37, 38
settings for VoIP calls . . . . . . . . 39, 40
VoIP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
Notification
incoming e-mail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
via SMS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
Number
as destination for room monitor . . . 85
copying from an SMS text . . . . . . . . 56
copying from directory . . . . . . . . . . 44
copying to directory . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
displaying caller's number (CLIP) . . . 29
entering network mailbox
number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78, 126
entering with directory . . . . . . . . . . 44
saving in the directory. . . . . . . . . . . 41
Number assignment . . . . . . . . . 120, 121
Numbers list, network provider . . . . . . 41
178
O
Offline (messenger) . . . . . . . . . . 71, 73
On/Off key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Online (messenger). . . . . . . . . . . 71, 73
Online directory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
Gigaset.net . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
register for access . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
Opening
incoming mail list . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Operating times of the handset . . . . 145
Operation (preparing to use the
phone) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
Order in directory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
Outbound proxy . . . . . . . . . . . 115, 166
mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
Own area code
setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95, 123
P
PABX
operating base station on PABX . . 102
pauses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
setting dialling mode . . . . . . . . . . 102
setting recall . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
SMS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
Pack contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
Paging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2, 82, 166
Pauses (PABX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
PC interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
Personal Identification Number . . . . 166
Personal provider data . . . . . . . . . . . 113
Phone
configuring via PC . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
functions, overview . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
menu overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
protecting (PIN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
setting (Web configurator) . . . . . . 108
setting base station (on handset) . . 96
setting up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
Phone connection
configuring (handset) . . . . . . . . . . 99
Phone jack pin configuration . . . . . . . 14
Phone status (Web configurator) . . . 135
Picture
deleting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
renaming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / S675-S685-IP_Lang_BASIX.fm / 27.10.08
Index
Picture-CLIP, see CLIP picture
PIN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
Playback (ans. mach.). . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
remote operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
Playing back
announcement (answer machine) . . 63
message (answer machine) . . . . . . . 63
POP3 server . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
Port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
Port forwarding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
Port number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
Power consumption
power consumption of
base station . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145
reducing for the base station . . . . . . 20
Pre-dialling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
Predictive text . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148
Preferred DNS server
entering (handset) . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
entering (Web configurator) . . . . . 109
Priority (messenger) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
Private IP address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
Problems and solutions . . . . . . . . . . 136
Protocol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
Proxy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
Proxy server . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
Proxy server address . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
Public IP address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
Q
Quality of Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
Questions and answers . . . . . . . . . . 136
Quick dial . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41, 43, 87
Version 4, 16.09.2005
R
RAM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
Random Access Memory . . . . . . . . . 167
Read Only Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
Reading message (messenger) . . . . . . 76
Reading the subject (e-mail) . . . . . . . . 69
Ready to chat (messenger) . . . . . . . . . 73
Recall . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
Recall key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
function for VoIP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
Receive number
answer machine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
assigning to answer machine . . . . 121
assigning to handset . . . . . . . . . . . 120
display on the handset . . . . . . . . . . 29
Recording
announcement/notification (answer
machine) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
quality (answer machine) . . . . . . . . 66
time (answer machine) . . . . . . . . . 66
two-way recording . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Registering
handset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12, 81
with the Web configurator . . . . . . 105
Registrar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
server . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
server port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
Registration name
e-mail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
VoIP account . . . . . . . . . 17, 101, 113
Registration password
e-mail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
VoIP account . . . . . . . . . 17, 101, 113
Registration refresh time . . . . . . . . . 114
Reminder call (anniversary) . . . . . . . . 45
Remote access to Web configurator . 110
Remote management . . . . . . . . . . . 110
Remote operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
Resetting
base station . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
handset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
Resource name (messenger) . . . . . . 127
RFC 2833 (DTMF signalling) . . . . . . . 122
Ringback
initiating (fixed line network) . . . . . 38
when busy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
when the call is not answered . . . 167
Ringer tone
activating/deactivating . . . . . . . . . . 89
changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
deactivating permanently. . . . . . . . 89
muting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
setting melody. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
setting volume . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
ROM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
Room monitor. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
Router . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
connecting base station . . . . . . . . . 15
Routing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
RSS feeds (info service) . . . . . . . . . . 128
RTP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
RTP port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122, 168
179
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / S675-S685-IP_Lang_BASIX.fm / 27.10.08
Index
Version 4, 16.09.2005
S
Safety precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
Scope of delivery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
Screensaver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Search for subscriber on Gigaset.net . . 34
Searching
for service information . . . . . . . . . 142
handset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
in directory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42
Selecting
announcement mode (ans. mach.) . 62
connection (line suffix) . . . . . . . . . . 27
entry (menu) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
online directory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
Send number
assigning to handset . . . . . . . . . . . 120
selecting via line suffix . . . . . . . . . . 27
Sender's address (e-mail) . . . . . . . . . . 70
Sensitivity (room monitor) . . . . . . . . . 85
Server . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
Server for firmware update . . . . . . . . 132
Server port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
Setting
base station . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
date/time on handset . . . . . . . . . . . 11
default connection . . . . . . . . . 98, 119
flash time (PABX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
handset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
online directory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
phone for VoIP telephony . . . . . . . 111
ringer tone melody . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
screensaver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
time zone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134
Shortcut (digit combination) . . . . . . . 21
Signal strength . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Signal tone, see Advisory tones
Simple Transversal of UDP over NAT . 168
SIP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
SIP address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
SIP Info (DTMF signalling) . . . . . . . . . 122
SIP port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122, 168
SIP provider . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
SIP proxy server . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
Slumber mode (alarm clock) . . . . . . . . 92
SMS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
activating/deactivating function . . . 59
changing mailbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
deleting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
180
draft message list . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
forwarding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
input language . . . . . . . . . . . 54, 149
linked . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
mailbox ID . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
notification by SMS . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
notification number . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
notification type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
PIN protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
reading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
receiving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
registration assistant . . . . . . . . . . . 53
replying to and forwarding . . . . . . . 56
rules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
saving number. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
self help with error messages . . . . . 60
sending to a personal
mailbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
setting up a mailbox . . . . . . . . . . . 57
to a PABX. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
writing/sending . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
SMS centre
changing number . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
Snooze (alarm clock) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
Sound, see Ringer tone
Special characters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145
Standard gateway
entering (handset) . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
entering (Web configurator) . . . . . 109
Star key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1, 89
Starting connection assistant
(menu) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
State of presence (messenger) . . . 71, 73
setting own . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
Static IP address . . . . . . . . . . . 109, 168
Status
buddy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
changing own (messenger) . . . . . . 73
VoIP connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
Status codes (VoIP)
activating display (handset) . . . . . 102
activating display (Web config.) . . 132
codes table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
Structure of IP address . . . . . . . . . . . 165
STUN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
STUN port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
STUN refresh time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / S675-S685-IP_Lang_BASIX.fm / 27.10.08
Index
STUN server . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
Submenu. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
Subnet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
Subnet mask . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
defining (handset) . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
defining (Web configurator) . . . . . 109
Suffix . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
dialling with . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
Summer time
changing automatically to . . . . . . . 134
Suppressing
speech pauses (VoIP) . . . . . . . . . . 119
Suppressing silence (VoIP) . . . . . . . . 119
Suppressing speech pauses (VoIP) . . . 119
Switching off
call forwarding (fixed line network) . 37
call forwarding (VoIP) . . . . . . . . . . . 39
Switching on
call forwarding (fixed line network) . 37
call forwarding (VoIP) . . . . . . . . . . . 39
Symmetric NAT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
Synchronisation with time server . . . 134
System settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
Version 4, 16.09.2005
T
Talk key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
TCP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
Telephone connection
configuring (Web config.) . . . . . . . 110
Text information in idle display
mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
Text message, see SMS
Time
set manually . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
transferring from time server . . . . 134
Time server . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134
TLS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
Toggling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
disconnecting call . . . . . . . . . . . 38, 40
fixed line network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
VoIP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
Touch tone dialling . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
Transferring PC address book
to directory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
Transmission Control Protocol . . . . . . 169
Transmission power
reducing for the base station . . . . . . 20
reducing for the handset . . . . . . . . . 20
Transmission rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
Transport Layer Security . . . . . . . . . . 169
Transport protocol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
e-mail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
general (table) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
Internet connection . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
SMS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
U
UDP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
Uniform Resource Identifier . . . . . . . 169
Universal Resource Locator . . . . . . . 169
Unknown . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
Unknown caller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
URI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
URL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
Use random ports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
User Datagram Protocol . . . . . . . . . . 169
User identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
User name
(VoIP-Account) . . . . . . 17, 100, 113
V
vCard format. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
vcf file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
Version check, automatic. . . . . . . . . 133
VIP (directory entry) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
Voice over Internet Protocol . . . . . 9, 169
Voice quality . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Voice quality and infrastructure . . . . 119
VoIP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
accepting/rejecting call waiting . . . 40
activate/deactivate network mailbox 78
activating/deactivating call waiting . 39
activating/deactivating status
message . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
advantages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
anonymous calling . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
assigning IP address . . . . . . . . . . . 101
call forwarding . . . . . . . . . . . . 39, 40
completing settings . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
conference call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
configuring account . . . . . . . . . . . 111
configuring account (first) . . . . . . . 17
connection name . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
enter network mailbox . . . . . . . . . . 78
external consultation call . . . . . . . . 40
loading provider data . . . 16, 100, 112
making call settings . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
network services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
phone number . . . . . . . . . . . 17, 112
181
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / S675-S685-IP_Lang_BASIX.fm / 27.10.08
Index
preconditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
setting call forwarding . . . . . . . . . 123
settings (on handset) . . . . . . . . . . . 99
show called party number . . . . . . . . 30
starting connection assistant . . . 15, 99
status codes (table) . . . . . . . . . . . 140
toggling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
withholding phone numbers . . . . . . 37
VoIP connection
activating/deactivating . . . . . 111, 116
automatic configuration . . . . . . . . 112
configuring (handset) . . . . . . . . . . . 99
configuring (Web configurator) . . . 111
line suffix . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
name (Web configurator) . . . . . . . 112
name/provider (Web config.) . . . . . 111
VoIP provider . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
downloading data. . . . . . 16, 100, 112
selecting (handset) . . . . . . . . . 16, 100
selecting (Web configurator) . . . . . 113
updating data automatically . . . . . 133
VoIP status messages
activating display (handset) . . . . . . 102
activating display (Web config.) . . . 132
status codes table . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
VoIP telephony
settings (Web config.) . . . . . . . . . . 111
VoIP user data
entering (connection assistant) . . . . 17
entering (handset) . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
entering (Web configurator) . . . . . 113
Volume
earpiece volume . . . . . . . . . . . . 32, 88
handsfree . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32, 88
loudspeaker . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
ringer tone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
Version 4, 16.09.2005
W
Wall mounting
base station . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
charging cradle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
WAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
Warning tone, see Advisory tones
Weather forecasts, in idle display
mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
Weather reports (info service) . . . . . 128
Web configurator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
(de)activating VoIP connection . . . 111
alternative DNS server. . . . . . . . . . 109
assign receive number . . . . . . . . . 121
182
assign receive number to
ans. mach. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
assigning receive number . . . . . . . 120
assigning send number . . . . . . . . 120
checking EEPROM version . . . . . . 135
checking firmware version . . . . . . 135
checking IP address . . . . . . . . . . . 135
checking MAC address . . . . . . . . . 135
connecting with PC . . . . . . . . . . . 104
creating e-mail settings . . . . . . . . 128
defining IP address . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
defining standard gateway . . . . . . 109
de-registering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
directory transfer . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
DTMF-reminder for VoIP . . . . . . . . 122
firmware update . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
interface language . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
IP configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
local network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
messenger access data . . . . . . . . . 126
name of a VoIP connection . . . . . . 112
name/provider of a connection . . . 111
number assignment . . . . . . . 120, 121
opening Web page . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
phone status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
preferred DNS server . . . . . . . . . . 109
remote access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
selecting IP address type . . . . . . . 109
setting phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
specifying dialling plans . . . . . . . . 124
status of a VoIP connection . . . . . 111
structure of the Web pages . . . . . . 106
subnet mask . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
Web interface, see Web configurator
Web page (Web configurator)
opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
Web server, see Web configurator
Wide Area Network . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
Withhold number display. . . . . . . . . . 37
Withhold phone number display . . . . 37
Working area (Web configurator) . . . 107
Writing (SMS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
Writing, editing text . . . . . . . . . . . . 147
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / montage_charger_base.fm / 27.10.08
Mounting the charging cradle to the wall, connecting the charging cradle
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Mounting the charging cradle to the wall, connecting the
charging cradle
183
Gigaset S685/S675 IP / GBR / A31008-M1919-L101-1-7619 / montage_charger_base.fm / 27.10.08
Mounting the base station to the wall
Version 4, 16.09.2005
Mounting the base station to the wall
184
Issued by
Gigaset Communications GmbH
Schlavenhorst 66, D-46395 Bocholt
Gigaset Communications GmbH is a trademark licensee of Siemens AG
© Gigaset Communications GmbH 2008
All rights reserved.
Subject to availability. Rights of modifications reserved.
www.gigaset.com